0% found this document useful (0 votes)
57 views139 pages

1969 - Douglas S Moser - Village - A Social Self-Sufficient Unit

Uploaded by

Amit Arora
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
57 views139 pages

1969 - Douglas S Moser - Village - A Social Self-Sufficient Unit

Uploaded by

Amit Arora
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 139

SOCIAL STRUCTURE IN VILLAGE INDIA

WITH PARTICULAR EMPHASIS ON THE


PANCHAYATI RAJ

by

DOUGLAS S. MOSER

B.A., Western Washington State College, 1963

A THESIS SUBMITTED IN PARTIAL FULFILMENT OF

THE REQUIREMENTS FOR THE DEGREE OF

Master of Arts

i n the Department

of

Anthropology and Sociology

We accept t h i s thesis as conforming to the

required standard

THE UNIVERSITY OF BRITISH COLUMBIA


In p r e s e n t i n g this thesis i n p a r t i a l f u l f i l m e n t of the requirements for

an advanced d e g r e e a t the U n i v e r s i t y o f B r i t i s h Columbia, I agree that

the L i b r a r y s h a l l make i t f r e e l y a v a i l a b l e f o r r e f e r e n c e and Study.

I f u r t h e r agree that p e r m i s s i o n f o r e x t e n s i v e copying of t h i s thesis

f o r s c h o l a r l y p u r p o s e s may be g r a n t e d by the Head o f my Department or

by his representatives. I t i s u n d e r s t o o d t h a t c o p y i n g or publication

of t h i s thes.is f o r f i n a n c i a l g a i n s h a l l not be allowed without my

written permission.

Department o f (XM^TN€^(^g \ yUi'U-^j

The U n i v e r s i t y o f B r i t i s h Columbia
V a n c o u v e r 8, Canada

X
Date |(Xvtit4^i % . (
ii

ABSTRACT

The v i l l a g e has been t h e s i g n i f i c a n t s o c i a l u n i t on t h e

I n d i a n subcontinent f o r thousands of y e a r s . To m a i n t a i n i t s

i n t e g r i t y i t has d e v e l o p e d a s e t o f i n t e r l o c k i n g structures,

some o f w h i c h a r e u n i q u e t o t h e s u b c o n t i n e n t , w h i c h a r e v e r y

r e s i s t a n t t o change. The I n d i a n n a t i o n a l government passed

l e g i s l a t i o n w h i c h p r o v i d e d f o r t h e f o r m a t i o n o f new structures

of p o l i t i c a l a l l o c a t i o n without p r o v i d i n g the basis o f sup-

port f o r changing the other r e l a t e d s t r u c t u r e s existing within

the v i l l a g e . T h i s t h e s i s a t t e m p t s t o show why t h i s p a r t i c u l a r

change, a d v o c a t e d by t h e s t a t e and n a t i o n a l g o v e r n m e n t s , failed.


iv

TABLE OF CONTENTS

CHAPTER PAGE

I. Introduction 1

P u r p o s e o f t h e Study 1

D i s c u s s i o n o f Reasons f o r t h e Use o f a
Typical Village 1
V i l l a g e as t h e B a s i c U n i t R a t h e r t h a n
Caste o r Household 3

Description of the T y p i c a l V i l l a g e 5

1. P o s i t i o n w i t h i n the Larger Setting 5


2. Description 13

II. Structures of Role D i f f e r e n t i a t i o n w i t h i n the


Village 20

Role D i f f e r e n t i a t i o n w i t h i n the Household 21

D e f i n i t i o n o f Household 22

Age as t h e B a s i s o f R o l e D i f f e r e n t i a t i o n 24

G e n e r a t i o n as t h e B a s i s o f R o l e D i f f e r e n t i -
ation 29

Sex as t h e B a s i s o f R o l e D i f f e r e n t i a t i o n 31

H o u s e h o l d S t a t u s as a Means o f R o l e
D i f f e r e n t i a t i o n w i t h i n the V i l l a g e 35
III. Structure of S o l i d a r i t y 46

S o l i d a r i t y S t r u c t u r e s w i t h i n the Household 48

1. • The F a t h e r - S o n R e l a t i o n s h i p 48

2. The B r o t h e r - B r o t h e r Relationship 52

S o l i d a r i t y Structures w i t h i n the V i l l a g e 55

S o l i d a r i t y Structures i n t h e C a s t e System 56

1. S o l i d a r i t y S t r u c t u r e s as t h e y order
Intracaste Relationships 56
V

CHAPTER PAGE

2. S o l i d a r i t y Structures i n Intercaste
Relationships 58
S o l i d a r i t y Structures w i t h i n the Jajmani
System 59

IV. The S t r u c t u r e o f Economic A l l o c a t i o n 63

D e f i n i t i o n o f Economic A l l o c a t i o n 63

The S u b s t r u c t u r e o f Economic P r o d u c t i o n 63

The J a j m a n i System 64

The J a j m a n i System as i t O p e r a t e s i n
Rampur 65

The S u b s t r u c t u r e o f Economic C o n s u m p t i o n 78

V. P o l i t i c a l A c t i v i t y w i t h i n the V i l l a g e 84

Size of Caste 87
P e r s o n a l i t y and Number o f P r o m i n e n t

I n d i v i d u a l s w i t h i n t h e Dominant C a s t e 88

Length of Residence i n the V i l l a g e 89

Type o f I s s u e 92

P a c t i o n s w i t h i n Nonland-owning Castes 93

S a n s k r i t i z a t i o n as a Long Term Political

Activity 95

S o u r c e s o f Power W i t h i n t h e V i l l a g e 97

VI. Panchayati Raj 103

BIBLIOGRAPHY 122

APPENDIX 128
vl

ACKNOWLEDGMENT

The author of t h i s t h e s i s would l i k e t o express h i s

a p p r e c i a t i o n t o h i s a d v i s o r , Mr. J e a n L o u i s de L a n n o y ,

and t o M i s s H e l g a J a c o b s o n , b o t h o f whom p r o v i d e d v a l u a b l e

criticism.
CHAPTER I

Introduction

PURPOSE OF THE PAPER

I propose to a n a l y z e the p a t t e r n s of s o c i a l interaction

in a t y p i c a l northcentral Indian v i l l a g e with particular

emphasis on the n a t u r e and direction o f s o c i a l change result-

ing f r o m the i n t r o d u c t i o n of f o r m a l p a n c h a y a t s . I shall be

examining i n p a r t i c u l a r the following analytic structures;

role differentiation, s o l i d a r i t y , economic a l l o c a t i o n , and

political allocation. Much o f what I s h a l l d i s c u s s w i l l be

couched i n a s e r i e s of h y p o t h e s e s w h i c h h o p e f u l l y can and

w i l l be t e s t e d i n the field a t some l a t e r date.

DISCUSSION OF REASONS FOR THE USE OF A TYPICAL VILLAGE

The r e a s o n s I have c h o s e n t o d i s c u s s s o c i a l Interaction

i n a t y p i c a l v i l l a g e r a t h e r than a p a r t i c u l a r village are

several. F i r s t , much of the d a t a I s h a l l use I s the result

of secondary analysis.

Second, many o f the data gathering agencies define the

v i l l a g e i n such f a s h i o n t h a t i t i s not really a social unit.

Thus, the n a t i o n a l agency whose j o b i t i s to collect taxes

may lump s e v e r a l v i l l a g e s t o g e t h e r w h i c h do not act as a social

unit i n o r d e r t h a t the collection of t a x e s might be expedited.

And the N a t i o n a l E x t e n s i o n S e r v i c e , c u t s and lumps the villages

i n an e n t i r e l y different way t h a n the tax collection agency.

1
The a d m i n i s t r a t i v e u n i t s o f t h e s e two government a g e n c i e s need

not c o i n c i d e . A g a i n , t h e Census B u r e a u has still another

d e f i n i t i o n o f what t h e y mean by t h e village.

T h i r d , the v i l l a g e r s t h e m s e l v e s as t h e a c t o r s d e f i n e t h e

v i l l a g e i n q u i t e d i f f e r i n g ways. F o r e x a m p l e , Andre B e t e i l e ,

in a r e c e n t p u b l i c a t i o n , p o i n t s out t h a t when B r a h m i n s a r e asked

to enumerate t h e i n h a b i t a n t s o f t h e v i l l a g e t h e y number o n l y

themselves, e x c l u d i n g a l l t h o s e who belong to other castes

r e s i d e n t i n the v i l l a g e . The Brahmins h a d n ' t t h o u g h t to

i n c l u d e t h e o t h e r c a s t e s u n t i l t h e f a c t o f e x c l u s i o n was pointed

out and even t h e n t h e y were h e s i t a n t b e c a u s e t h e o t h e r s owned no

p r o p e r t y i n t h e v i l l a g e o t h e r t h a n p e r s o n a l p r o p e r t y and very

little of t h a t . To t h e o u t s i d e r i t m i g h t seem t h a t t h e

Brahmins t h o u g h t o f t h e o t h e r r e s i d e n t s as coming w i t h t h e
1

land. T h i s o b s e r v a t i o n was made i n s o u t h e r n I n d i a and may

o r may not o c c u r i n o t h e r p a r t s o f I n d i a . (That other

r e s e a r c h e r s have n o t m e n t i o n e d t h i s does n o t mean t h a t t h i s

s o r t o f s i t u a t i o n does not e x i s t ; i t may merely mean t h a t t h e

question.has n e v e r been asked i n t h a t manner.)

F o u r t h and f i n a l l y , t h e r e I s t h e p r o b l e m o f t h e p a t t e r n o f

settlement. Some v i l l a g e s a r e compact, c e n t r a l l y l o c a t e d b l o c k s

of houses. Some a r e o f t h e d i s p e r s e d h a m l e t t y p e and still

o t h e r s are o f t h e d i s p e r s e d h o u s e h o l d type. Some o f t h e vil-

l a g e s w h i c h I s h a l l r e f e r t o a r e i n f a c t d i s p e r s e d h a m l e t s even

though t h e y i n t e r a c t i n much t h e same way as t h e v i l l a g e s w h i c h


are o f the compact s e t t l e m e n t t y p e . 2
3

WHY USE THE VILLAGE AS THE BASIC UNIT RATHER THAN CASTE
OR HOUSEHOLD
A p e r t i n e n t q u e s t i o n at t h i s p o i n t i s : Why choose t h e

v i l l a g e as t h e s o c i a l u n i t r a t h e r t h a n c a s t e o r h o u s e h o l d ?

I n my e s t i m a t i o n the v i l l a g e I s the c l o s e s t t h i n g t o b e i n g a

s e l f - s u f f i c i e n t s o c i a l u n i t t h a t can be found i n I n d i a . Neither

t h e h o u s e h o l d n o r t h e c a s t e can be c o n s i d e r e d as self-sufficient

u n i t s i n terms o f e i t h e r economic a l l o c a t i o n o f goods and ser-

v i c e s or p o l i t i c a l a l l o c a t i o n o f power and authority. There

a r e a c o n s i d e r a b l e number o f o u t s i d e f o r c e s w h i c h Impinge upon

the d e c i s i o n - m a k i n g powers o f e i t h e r o f t h e s e two units. To

use e i t h e r u n i t as t h e b a s i s f o r a n a l y s i s w o u l d e x c l u d e much

significant interaction. The h o u s e h o l d and t h e c a s t e do, of

c o u r s e , make d e c i s i o n s t h a t a f f e c t t h e a c t i o n s o f t h e members,

but a l a r g e number o f d e c i s i o n s can be and a r e made f o r t h e

members o f the c a s t e o r h o u s e h o l d I n w h i c h t h e s e members have

no p a r t i n t h e d e c i s i o n - m a k i n g process. The r e a s o n s I have

a p p l i e d f o r not u s i n g e i t h e r c a s t e o r h o u s e h o l d may be l e v e l e d

by some a g a i n s t my choice of the v i l l a g e f o r the v i l l a g e i s

"not c o m p l e t e l y self-sufficient either. The i n t e r a c t i o n which

o c c u r s between v i l l a g e s cannot be i g n o r e d and I s h a l l have

o c c a s i o n t o d i s c u s s t h i s i n t e r a c t i o n , b u t , on t h e w h o l e , t h e

significant interaction (e.g., p o l i t i c a l and economic activity)

does o c c u r w i t h i n the v i l l a g e p r o p e r ( s i g n i f i c a n t i n terms o f

t h e amount o f i n t e r a c t i o n and t h e t y p e o f i n t e r a c t i o n ) . Per-

haps t h e s i n g l e most i m p o r t a n t p a t t e r n o f behaviour w h i c h i s


4

not v i l l a g e o r i e n t e d i s t h a t w h i c h i s b a s e d on the marriage

o f v i l l a g e males t o e x t r a - v i l l a g e f e m a l e s . I n most villages

there i s a l s o some t r a d i n g f o r s p e c i a l i z e d p r o d u c t s and some

sharing o f the t a l e n t s o f s p e c i a l i z e d labourers.

Defining as the s o c i a l u n i t a n y t h i n g l a r g e r than the vil-

l a g e w o u l d be m i s l e a d i n g . Only on s p e c i a l o c c a s i o n s do

residents o f two adjacent v i l l a g e s cooperate—normally one

would expect h o s t i l i t y r a t h e r than c o o p e r a t i o n . Caste-mates

from a d j a c e n t v i l l a g e s o c c a s i o n a l l y work t o g e t h e r i n c e r e m o n i e s

r e l a t e d t o b i r t h , m a r r i a g e , and d e a t h t o make a b i g g e r show

f o r the r e s t o f t h e i r own v i l l a g e and Improve t h e i r prestige.

Within the v i l l a g e i t i s p o s s i b l e t o see antagonistic groups,

but t h i s antagonism i s m i t i g a t e d by t h e need t o c o o p e r a t e i n

m a t t e r s economic o r p o l i t i c a l . Above t h e v i l l a g e l e v e l s u c h

i s not the case. V i l l a g e s do not need t o c o o p e r a t e t o ensure

economic s u r v i v a l . The production u n i t i s s m a l l enough t o

be easily contained w i t h i n the v i l l a g e . P o l i t i c a l groups or

f a c t i o n s w i t h i n the v i l l a g e are often quite antagonistic,

but, again, t h i s i s m i t i g a t e d by the existence of o t h e r kinds

o f t i e s s u c h as c a s t e bonds w h i c h do not operate effectively

above t h e v i l l a g e level.

I t must be constantly k e p t i n mind t h a t t h r o u g h o u t the

paper, unless o t h e r w i s e s t a t e d , I am talking about a typical

village. There i s a g r e a t d e a l of v a r i a t i o n i n v i l l a g e social

s t r u c t u r e w i t h i n any one region and obviously there i s even

more v a r i a t i o n when I n d i a i s t a k e n as a w h o l e . The typical


5

v i l l a g e under a n a l y s i s i n t h i s s t u d y w i l l more c l o s e l y resemble

what i s g e n e r a l l y known about n o r t h c e n t r a l I n d i a t h a n any of

the other r e g i o n s . There w i l l , o f c o u r s e , be some s i m i l a r i t i e s

between r e g i o n s . On some o c c a s i o n s i n t h i s paper I s h a l l infer

or h y p o t h e s i z e behaviour p a t t e r n s f o r the n o r t h c e n t r a l p o r t i o n

o f t h e c o n t i n e n t w h i c h have n o t been o b s e r v e d ( m a i n l y , I am

a s s u m i n g , because no one has l o o k e d f o r them o r t h o u g h t t o look

for them) e x c e p t i n o t h e r r e g i o n s . To do a p r o p e r j o b f o r t h e

whole o f I n d i a one w o u l d have t o e s t a b l i s h t y p i c a l villages

for each o f t h e m a j o r r e g i o n a l v a r i a n t s , w h i c h l i e s beyond

the scope o f t h i s p r o j e c t .

DESCRIPTION OP THE TYPICAL VILLAGE

To put the t y p i c a l v i l l a g e i n p r o p e r p e r s p e c t i v e I t h i n k

it i s necessary t o d e s c r i b e the n a t i o n a l s e t t i n g i n which the

v i l l a g e m i g h t be f o u n d as w e l l as t h e v i l l a g e i t s e l f . So I

b e g i n t h i s s e c t i o n w i t h a b r i e f d e s c r i p t i o n of the l a r g e r

s e t t i n g i n which the v i l l a g e f i n d s itself.

1. P o s i t i o n o f t h e V i l l a g e w i t h i n the L a r g e r S e t t i n g

I n d i a i s t h e second most p o p u l o u s n a t i o n on t h e earth.

The p o p u l a t i o n i n 1961 was 436,424,429.^ It i s largely a

p e a s a n t t y p e a g r i c u l t u r a l n a t i o n w i t h o n l y a few large centers

of p o p u l a t i o n . The 1961 S t a t i s t i c a l Abstract l i s t s only 2,609


5
c e n t e r s whose p o p u l a t i o n I s g r e a t e r ^ t h a n 5,000. There are a
6

few very large centers of population like Calcutta, Bombay,

and New D e l h i , but even these large cities seem t o differ

greatly^ from large cities i n most W e s t e r n n a t i o n s . In 1961


7
roughly 82 per cent of the total population was living in

approximately 558,000 villages of less than 5,000 i n h a b i t a n t s .

(The Census Bureau d e f i n e s the village as having less than 500

inhabitants.) Since this means t h a t the average village size

can only be about 640 there are obviously thousands of villages

w h i c h may have only two or three hundred inhabitants. Most of

these villages contain within their borders little more land

in numbers of acres than they have inhabitants (this varies

from r e g i o n to region). In the northwest of India the villages

tend t o be l a r g e r and the land/man r a t i o s higher because the

soil i s not as productive. In some p a r t s of the northeast and

in the south the village population i s smaller and the village

land holdings are less, both because i t i s more p r o d u c t i v e land

and because there are more p e o p l e . The f u r t h e r south one travels

in I n d i a the more one is likely to see dispersed hamlets or

households. People live on high ground wherever i t exists

because of the annual threat of floods, rather than form fairly

large compact settlements i n the center of the fields as they

do i n the north of India. This high ground i s often around the

tanks ( p o n d s ) and i s the result of the original preparation as

well as the r e p a i r of the tank.

The climate of India varies widely from desert type condi-

tions t o monsoon t y p e weather. Soil type varies with the


7

a l t i t u d e , type of parent rock from which the s o i l i s d e r i v e d ,

and t h e amount o f r a i n f a l l . And as t h e s e f a c t o r s v a r y so do

t h e t y p e s o f c r o p s w h i c h may be grown. Southern and eastern

I n d i a are b a s i c a l l y r i c e - g r o w i n g areas. The d r i e r areas i n

the northwest are predominantly wheat and m i l l e t - g r o w i n g a r e a s .

N o r t h c e n t r a l I n d i a a g r i c u l t u r a l i s t s grow b o t h t y p e s o f crops

d e p e n d i n g upon t h e amount o f w a t e r a v a i l a b l e . G e n e r a l l y the

w e t t e r p a r t s of the v i l l a g e lands are g i v e n over t o r i c e and

t h e d r i e r p a r t s t o wheat o r m i l l e t . Supplementary crops appro-

p r i a t e t o the g r o w i n g c o n d i t i o n s a r e grown w h e r e v e r p o s s i b l e on

t h e v i l l a g e l a n d s and c a s h c r o p s a r e b e g i n n i n g t o be grown on

increasingly large acreages.

U n t i l r e c e n t l y the s u b c o n t i n e n t has been a b l e t o p r o d u c e

enough t o meet i t s c o n s u m p t i o n needs i n most y e a r s , g i v e n the

s t a t e of t h e t e c h n i c a l a r t s . There have been p e r i o d i c f a m i n e s


9
a l l through India's history but the b u l k of these famines can

be a t t r i b u t e d t o l a c k o f d i s t r i b u t i o n f a c i l i t i e s r a t h e r than

to any absolute l a c k of p r o d u c t i o n . ( V i l l a g e r s I n one locality

c o u l d be s t a r v i n g w h i l e j u s t f i f t y m i l e s away t h e r e m i g h t be a

surplus.) The l o c a l f a m i n e s were n o r m a l l y t h e r e s u l t o f p o o r

rainfall. Oscar L e w i s p o i n t s out t h a t t h e r e i s g r e a t varia-

t i o n not o n l y i n t h e m o n t h l y amount o f r a i n b u t i n t h e y e a r l y

amount as w e l l . 1 0
The s i t u a t i o n p r e s e n t l y i s more g r i m . With

t h e tremendous i n c r e a s e i n p o p u l a t i o n i n t h e l a s t few decades

even good crop y e a r s do not p r o v i d e enough f o o d , and when t h e

r a i n s f a i l o r come a t t h e wrong t i m e as t h e y have i n t h e last

few y e a r s i n I n d i a f a m i n e r u n s r a m p a r t . Only t h e s h i p m e n t o f
8

l a r g e q u a n t i t i e s o f g r a i n f r o m s u r p l u s n a t i o n s has k e p t India

from s u f f e r i n g t h e death of millions of her inhabitants.

U n f o r t u n a t e l y t h e s i t u a t i o n c a n o n l y g e t worse as f u r t h e r

p o p u l a t i o n i n c r e a s e s a r e marked.

I n d i a i s j u s t b e g i n n i n g t o develop industrially. She has

a f a i r l y good s u p p l y o f t h e b a s i c m i n e r a l s needed f o r i n d u s -

trialization, 1 1
and good s o u r c e s o f power i n t h e many rivers

w h i c h come down f r o m t h e H i m a l a y a s and f r o m t h e c e n t r a l h i g h -

12

lands. Development o f t h e s e r e s o u r c e s r e q u i r e s , among o t h e r

t h i n g s , c a p i t a l and t r a i n e d manpower ( b o t h s k i l l e d l a b o u r and

t r a i n e d management) b o t h o f w h i c h a r e I n v e r y s h o r t supply.

India's great problem i s her r a p i d l y expanding p o p u l a t i o n

w h i c h e a t s up any economic g a i n s she c a n make. Very l i t t l e of

t h e government's e f f o r t t o r a i s e t h e s t a n d a r d o f l i v i n g of the

average I n d i a n through i n c r e a s e d c r o p p r o d u c t i o n and i n d u s t r i a l -

i z a t i o n reaches t h e average peasant. T h i s i s made f a i r l y obvious

I n t h e w r i t i n g s o f v a r i o u s a u t h o r s who have been c o n c e r n e d with

13

the problem. ^ Many v i l l a g e s a r e n o t even aware t h a t t h e

n a t i o n a l government has f o r m u l a t e d F i v e Y e a r P l a n s t o a i d them

to i n c r e a s e crop p r o d u c t i o n .

Politically I n d i a i s a very d i v i d e d n a t i o n . The o r i g i n a l

d i v i s i o n of the subcontinent a t the time o f independence i n

19^7 i n t o I n d i a and P a k i s t a n was c a u s e d p r i m a r i l y by t h e f e a r s

o f t h e M u s l i m m i n o r i t y t h a t t h e y w o u l d be swamped by t h e m a j o r -

i t y who a r e f o l l o w e r s o f t h e H i n d u r e l i g i o n . The s e p a r a t i o n o f

t h e two n a t i o n s on t h e b a s i s o f r e l i g i o n has n o t been e n t i r e l y


9

s u c c e s s f u l i n t h a t s o m e t h i n g o v e r 35 m i l l i o n s o f M u s l i m s were
14
s t i l l l i v i n g i n I n d i a a t t h e t i m e o f t h e 1951 c e n s u s . Reli-
g i o n i s a p r o b l e m i n I n d i a , b u t t h e b i t t e r n e s s w h i c h was so

e v i d e n t i n 1947 i s somewhat l e s s t o d a y . The l o c a l p e o p l e i n

each c o u n t r y s t i l l p e r i o d i c a l l y p u t p r e s s u r e on t h e m i n o r i t y

t o c l e a r o u t , b u t i t seems t h a t t h e y a r e l i v i n g t o g e t h e r i n

much t h e same f a s h i o n t h a t t h e y d i d p r e v i o u s t o Independence.

P r o b a b l y t h e most d i v i s i v e f o r c e i n e f f e c t t o d a y i n I n d i a

i s t h e f r i c t i o n between t h e v a r i o u s l a n g u a g e g r o u p s . No

s i n g l e l a n g u a g e can come even c l o s e t o e n c o m p a s s i n g a majority

of c i t i z e n s . H i n d i , Urdu and P u n j a b i a r e t h e most commonly

spoken l a n g u a g e s and between them t h e y number j u s t s h o r t o f

150 m i l l i o n s of speakers. The t w e l v e m a j o r l a n g u a g e s men-

t i o n e d i n t h e I n d i a n C o n s t i t u t i o n number r o u g h l y 323 millions

of speakers. There a r e 47 o t h e r l a n g u a g e s whose s p e a k e r s

number o v e r 1 0 0 , 0 0 0 . In a d d i t i o n t o these languages t h e r e


15
a r e a f u r t h e r 720 m i n o r l a n g u a g e s . The boundary location

of t h e I n d i a n s t a t e s has been d r a s t i c a l l y e f f e c t e d by language

and t h e r e i s c o n s t a n t a g i t a t i o n f r o m some l a n g u a g e groups t o

f o r m new s t a t e s on t h e b a s i s o f l a n g u a g e .

In the r e c e n t past v e r y s e r i o u s language r i o t s have

occurred. These r i o t s a t t i m e s have r e a c h e d t h e p r o p o r t i o n s

o f communal r i o t s ^ w h i c h t o o k p l a c e between Hindus and M u s l i m s


1

b e f o r e and d u r i n g Independence. The m u l t i p l i c i t y o f l a n g u a g e s

i s a s e r i o u s problem at the n a t i o n a l l e v e l , but at the local

v i l l a g e l e v e l t h e v i l l a g e r s do n o t r e a l l y g e t i n v o l v e d unless
10

t h e y l i v e i n an a r e a w h i c h i s t r a n s i t i o n a l between two lan-

guages or i n a r e g i o n i n w h i c h two l a n g u a g e s are u s e d by groups

w h i c h have commingled. An i n t e r e s t i n g example o f c o m m i n g l i n g

is the Punjab. The m a l e s speak b o t h U r d u and P u n j a b i and the


17

f e m a l e s speak o n l y P u n j a b i . By and l a r g e , however, t h e vil-

l a g e r s a r e unaware o f t h e n a t i o n a l l a n g u a g e p r o b l e m f o r t h e y

have o n l y s p o r a d i c c o n t a c t w i t h t h e o u t s i d e w o r l d and t h a t gen-

e r a l l y w i t h agencies which are s e r v i c e o r i e n t e d .

Politics i n I n d i a have become i n c r e a s i n g l y c o n f u s e d as

t h e number o f p o l i t i c a l p a r t i e s p r o l i f e r a t e s . There was really

o n l y one p a r t y a t t h e t i m e of i n d e p e n d e n c e — t h e C o n g r e s s P a r t y .

A l m o s t i t s s o l e r e a s o n f o r e x i s t e n c e was t o g a i n freedom f o r

I n d i a from the B r i t i s h Empire. S i n c e i t was the o n l y n a t i o n a l

p o l i t i c a l p a r t y and was f a i r l y w e l l organized, the Congress

P a r t y assumed p o l i t i c a l c o n t r o l o f I n d i a . I t very q u i c k l y

became e v i d e n t t h a t t h e C o n g r e s s P a r t y was l i t t l e more t h a n

a v e r y l o o s e c o a l i t i o n o f i n t e r e s t g r o u p s who had but one

common i n t e r e s t — f r e e d o m f r o m B r i t a i n because o p p o s i t i o n w i t h i n

the r a n k s soon d e v e l o p e d c o n c e r n i n g the d i r e c t i o n i n which the

p a r t y was t o move and t h e means f o r a t t a i n i n g g o a l s . The results

of t h e 1951 e l e c t i o n s showed t h a t the C o n g r e s s P a r t y was still

t h e most p o w e r f u l , w i n n i n g 357 seats i n a Parliament of 489-


18
They had, however, o n l y about 45 p e r c e n t o f the p o p u l a r vote.

That t h e y won such a h i g h p e r c e n t a g e o f t h e Parliamentary

s e a t s w i t h such a s m a l l p e r c e n t a g e of t h e p o p u l a r vote may

be a t t r i b u t e d t o t h e l a r g e number o f m i n o r p a r t i e s
11

contesting the e l e c t i o n . Even t h o u g h t h e C o n g r e s s P a r t y was

the most p o w e r f u l p a r t y and formed t h e government t h e y d i d n o t

have t h e k i n d o f s u p p o r t n e c e s s a r y t o p r e s e n t and c a r r y o u t

the s o r t o f f o r c e f u l p r o g r a m needed t o b r i n g I n d i a i n t o t h e

i n d u s t r i a l world. I n more r e c e n t e l e c t i o n s t h e C o n g r e s s Party

has received even l e s s p o p u l a r s u p p o r t . They a r e s t i l l t h e

l a r g e s t o f t h e n a t i o n a l p a r t i e s , b u t t h e i r e f f e c t i v e n e s s has

been g r e a t l y reduced.
There i s a l a r g e number o f s p l i n t e r p a r t i e s and t h e number

seems t o be I n c r e a s i n g . I n t h e 1951 e l e c t i o n s t h e r e were 14

parties entering as n a t i o n a l p a r t i e s , 51 more as s t a t e parties

and i n a d d i t i o n t o t h e p a r t i e s t h e r e were a tremendous number

of i n d e p e n d e n t s . ( s o m e o f whom were f o r m e r p r i n c e s o f t h e more

t h a n 500 P r i n c e l y S t a t e s of pre-lndependence I n d i a ) . None

of t h e s e p a r t i e s has a l a r g e n a t i o n a l f o l l o w i n g and few o f them

have enough i n t e r e s t s i n common t o a t t e m p t t o f o r m some k i n d o f

coalition. About t h e o n l y t h i n g t h e y have i n common i s o p p o s i -

t i o n t o t h e Congress R a j . They seem u n a b l e t o p r e s e n t any s o r t

of v i a b l e , r e s p o n s i b l e program b e c a u s e t h e i r i n t e r e s t s a r e

d i r e c t e d t o t h e a c h i e v e m e n t o f s p e c i f i c , group o r i e n t e d goals.

The s p l i n t e r p a r t i e s seem t o be o f t h r e e s o r t s ; first,

r e g i o n a l p a r t i e s , the basis f o r membership o f w h i c h i s t h e a r e a

i n w h i c h one l i v e s and t h e l a n g u a g e one s p e a k s ; s e c o n d , c a s t e

p a r t i e s , t h e membership o f w h i c h i s b a s e d on I n c l u s i o n i n a

p a r t i c u l a r caste; and t h i r d , i d e o l o g i c a l l y b a s e d p a r t i e s whose

membership i s r e c r u i t e d on t h e b a s i s of b e l i e f i n a p a r t i c u l a r
12

ideology. These p a r t i e s g e n e r a l l y have a f a i r l y solid local

b a s i s , but this p o w e r on the l o c a l l e v e l does not give them

any p o w e r on the n a t i o n a l l e v e l except perhaps to block local

Congress moves. I t i s q u i t e p o s s i b l e t o draw a p a r a l l e l between

these p a r t i e s and, f o r example, the Social Credit Party in

British Columbia. The Social Credit Party i s powerful i n

British Columbia but has little influence at the national

level.

A g a i n , at the village l e v e l , the villager i s not really

aware o f the n a t i o n a l s i g n i f i c a n c e of the local party plat-

f o r m s i f , i n f a c t , he is truly aware t h a t India i s a nation.

The p o l i t i c a l p a r t i e s on the n a t i o n a l scene have the knack of

arriving i n the village only during e l e c t i o n times fully

expecting the villagers t o be knowledgeable and ready to

s u p p o r t them o n l y to find t h a t the villagers d o n ' t e v e n know

who they are. The only kind of p l a t f o r m which the local resi-

dents can u n d e r s t a n d i s one which deals with local problems.

I suspect that this i s one of the reasons f o r the proliferation

of state parties. I n o r d e r t o get and maintain local support,

broad n a t i o n a l issues are avoided and, of c o u r s e , each region

has I t s own particular issues.

Many v i l l a g e r s are disillusioned about a l l p o l i t i c a l


20

parties and don't r e a l l y understand the election process.

They have n e v e r b e f o r e i n t h e i r p a s t b e e n a s k e d t o make a

choice b e t w e e n two sets of l e a d e r s . A l o t of the villagers

are of the opinion that the government ought t o h e l p them with


13

t h e i r p r o b l e m s s i n c e i t i s t h e government t h a t i s t h e a u t h o r

o f schemes i n v o l v i n g s a n i t a t i o n , r o a d b u i l d i n g , s c h o o l s ,

formal panchayats, e t c . , and t h e v i l l a g e r s s e e t h e s e schemes

as c a u s i n g changes w h i c h t h e y cannot cope w i t h a t t h e v i l l a g e

level.

Keeping i n mind t h a t t h e l a s t few pages have d e s c r i b e d

t h e I n d i a n a t i o n a l scene i n o n l y a r u d i m e n t a r y way I s h o u l d

now l i k e t o d e s c r i b e t h e t y p i c a l village.

2. Description

The t y p i c a l v i l l a g e i s s m a l l , n u m b e r i n g somewhere between

500 and 700 i n h a b i t a n t s . Some v i l l a g e s may be s m a l l e r , b u t

t h e y v e r y r a r e l y number b e l o w 200 t o 3 0 0 . Villages larger

t h a n around 1000 s t a r t t o become s o m e t h i n g o t h e r t h a n a t y p i c a l

village.

The a r a b l e l a n d c o n t r o l l e d by t h e v i l l a g e r s i s h a r d l y

more i n a c r e s t h a n t h e r e a r e i n h a b i t a n t s . Although I t can

v a r y w i d e l y , t h e man/acre r a t i o i s t y p i c a l l y n e a r one. Rampur

had a man/acre r a t i o o f 1.22 i n 1940 and by t h e t i m e o f L e w i s '

s t u d y i n 1952 t h e r a t i o had changed t o .71. The change r e s u l t e d

f r o m a p o p u l a t i o n g r o w t h o f 645 i n 19^0 t o 1095 i n 1 9 5 2 . 2 2

The s e t t l e m e n t p a t t e r n i s o f t h e compact s o r t . The r e s i -

d e n t s l i v e , jammed v e r y c l o s e l y t o g e t h e r , I n a more o r l e s s

c e n t r a l l y l o c a t e d area. I n the densest part of the v i l l a g e

each house may s h a r e t h r e e o f i t s w a l l s w i t h t h r e e neighbours.

Around t h e p e r i m e t e r t h e houses w i l l be more w i d e l y spaced.


14

Who l i v e s where i n t h e v i l l a g e depends n o r m a l l y upon two t h i n g s .

F e l l o w c a s t e members t e n d t o c l u s t e r i n one a r e a o f t h e v i l l a g e .

This i s p a r t i c u l a r l y t r u e o f b o t h t h e h i g h and l o w c a s t e s and

not so t r u e o f t h e middle castes. The h i g h c a s t e and low c a s t e

groups a r e n o r m a l l y s i t u a t e d as f a r f r o m one a n o t h e r as p o s s i b l e
23
and still remain w i t h i n the confines o f the v i l l a g e . The

second f a c t o r o p e r a t i o n a l i n d e t e r m i n i n g residence patterns

w i t h i n t h e s e t t l e m e n t has t o do w i t h t h e t i m e a t w h i c h t h e

f a m i l y became r e s i d e n t s i n t h e v i l l a g e and t h e space a v a i l a b l e

f o r home b u i l d i n g . The l a t e r a r r i v a l s i n the v i l l a g e o f t e n must

t a k e what i s l e f t o v e r . T h i s means t h a t some m i x i n g o f c a s t e s

does o c c u r — m a i n l y i n t h e m i d d l e - r a n g e c a s t e s , however.

The economy o f t h e v i l l a g e i s b a s e d on t h e l a n d . Only

r e c e n t l y have t h e v i l l a g e r s began g o i n g o u t s i d e t h e v i l l a g e t o

o b t a i n j o b s and t o p u r c h a s e c o n s u m p t i o n goods. Traditionally

the v i l l a g e produced, w i t h a few minor e x c e p t i o n s , everything

t h a t i t consumed. The b a s i c d i e t consisted of the various

c e r e a l g r a i n s w h i c h were a p p r o p r i a t e t o t h e c l i m a t e and s o i l

conditions. Most v i l l a g e s have l a n d t h a t i s a b l e t o s u p p o r t

both r i c e (commonly c a l l e d paddy) and wheat o r m i l l e t . The

w e t t e r areas of the v i l l a g e lands are normally double—cropped;

paddy i n t h e wet s e a s o n and d r y l a n d g r a i n i n t h e d r y s e a s o n .

The drier l a n d s a r e s i n g l e — c r o p p e d w i t h wheat, m i l l e t , o r some

other l o c a l e q u i v a l e n t . A few v e g e t a b l e s a r e grown t o be u s e d

i n sauces, and sometimes a few f r u i t t r e e s are p l a n t e d .

C a t t l e are a part of the v i l l a g e s c e n e — a very necessary

part. Animals are v i r t u a l l y the only source o f m o t i v e power i n


15

the v i l l a g e . The b u l l o c k s , b u f f a l o e s , and cows a r e n o r m a l l y

a l l present. The b u l l o c k s a r e t h e work a n i m a l s , p u l l i n g t h e

p l o w s and c a r t s as w e l l as d r a w i n g t h e w a t e r f r o m t h e v i l l a g e

w e l l s f o r i r r i g a t i o n purposes. B u f f a l o e s and cows a r e u s e d

primarily f o rmilking. The cow i s u s u a l l y l e s s abundant

b e c a u s e i t i s n o t as good a p r o d u c e r as t h e b u f f a l o . The m i l k
24
i s n o t n o r m a l l y d r u n k , b u t r a t h e r i s t h e s o u r c e o f ghee.

There may be a few o t h e r a n i m a l s s u c h as g o a t s , s h e e p , d o n k e y s ,

and even t h e odd mule o r camel p r e s e n t as w e l l . Aside from the

more o b v i o u s uses t h a t t h e s e a n i m a l s a r e p u t t o t h e y a r e u s e d

a d d i t i o n a l l y as a v e r y i m p o r t a n t s o u r c e o f f u e l . One o f t h e

most common s i g h t s i n t h e v i l l a g e i s t h e dung cakes w h i c h a r e

p a t t e d i n t o shape b y v i l l a g e women and d r i e d on t h e w a l l s and

r o o f s o f t h e houses t o be u s e d as f u e l f o r c o o k i n g and sometimes


even f o r h e a t i n g .
Most i n d i v i d u a l s work d i r e c t l y on t h e l a n d as f a r m e r s o r

l a n d l e s s l a b o u r e r s and t h o s e who do n o t c e r t a i n l y depend indi-

r e c t l y upon t h e l a n d . The v a r i o u s a r t i s a n s l i v i n g i n t h e v i l l a g e

trade t h e i r services d i r e c t l y f o r food. Not e v e r y o n e owns l a n d .

U s u a l l y t h e dominant c a s t e owns a l l b u t a few a c r e s , w h i c h they

may o r may n o t d i r e c t l y f a r m t h e m s e l v e s . Whether o r n o t t h e y

do depends upon w h i c h caste they belong t o . F a r m e r c a s t e s do

c u l t i v a t e and Brahmin's u s u a l l y do n o t . (They a r e p r o b a b l y more

apt t o do so i n n o r t h c e n t r a l I n d i a t h a n i n s o u t h e r n I n d i a . ) The

c a s t e w h i c h owns t h e l a n d and c u l t i v a t e s i t ( o r h a s i t c u l t i v a t e d )

I s t h e dominant c a s t e i n t h e v i l l a g e . The dominant c a s t e i n t h e


16

v i l l a g e i s not always at the top of r i t u a l h i e r a r c h y . Which

c a s t e i s dominant i s u s u a l l y d e t e r m i n e d by e v e n t s i n the long

p a s t h i s t o r y o f t h e v i l l a g e and t h e r e g i o n i n w h i c h i t i s

located.

Although the caste c o m p o s i t i o n o f t h e v i l l a g e can vary

w i d e l y , most v i l l a g e s c o n t a i n enough d i f f e r e n t c a s t e s t o e n s u r e

t h a t t h e v i t a l t a s k s be c a r r i e d o u t . To have t o o few castes

g e n e r a l l y means t h a t t h e v i l l a g e w i l l have t o depend upon o u t -

s i d e r s t o come i n and do some o f t h e v i l l a g e work, The greater

the extent t o which t h i s i s necessary the l e s s the village

operates as t h e s i g n i f i c a n t social unit. In the t y p i c a l village

t h e r e i s a s i n g l e dominant a g r i c u l t u r a l c a s t e w h i c h numbers a t

l e a s t h a l f of the v i l l a g e p o p u l a t i o n . Because c a s t e i s s i m i l a r

t o a c l o s e d u n i o n w i t h r e g a r d t o o c c u p a t i o n t h e number o f other

occupations p r a c t i s e d w i t h i n t h e v i l l a g e i n d i c a t e d t h e number

of other castes i n the v i l l a g e . Most o f t h e common occupations

are r e p r e s e n t e d — s o m e by p e r h a p s o n l y one f a m i l y because the

v i l l a g e hasn't the business t o s u p p o r t more t h a n one. The

o u t c a s t e s or u n t o u c h a b l e s a r e o f t e n t h e second l a r g e s t group

i n the v i l l a g e p o p u l a t i o n . The o u t c a s t e s a r e v i e w e d as one

l a r g e group by t h e o t h e r c a s t e s i n t h e v i l l a g e even t h o u g h , I n

r e a l i t y they d i f f e r e n t i a t e between t h e m s e l v e s i n much t h e same

f a s h i o n as do t h e c a s t e s . I t i s mostly the untouchables who

work as l a n d l e s s l a b o u r e r s f o r t h e dominant c u l t i v a t o r caste.

Political i n t e r a c t i o n w i t h i n t h e v i l l a g e , and f o r t h a t

matter o u t s i d e t h e v i l l a g e , i s c o n t r o l l e d by the dominant

caste. I n some ways one can say t h a t t h e o n l y significant


17

political i n t e r a c t i o n t h a t occurs i n the v i l l a g e i s w i t h i n the

ranks o f t h e dominant c a s t e . ( T h i s w i l l be d i s c u s s e d more

fully i n C h a p t e r V.) D e p e n d i n g upon t h e m a t t e r under c o n s i d e r a -

t i o n t h e dominant c a s t e does o r does n o t a c t as a u n i f i e d body.

S p l i t s i n caste s o l i d a r i t y g e n e r a l l y occur only i n those matters

where c o n t r o l o f t h e o t h e r c a s t e s i n t h e v i l l a g e i s n o t a q u e s t i o n .

The above d e s c r i p t i o n s o f I n d i a as a whole and t h e typical

I n d i a n v i l l a g e a r e v e r y g e n e r a l and are g i v e n only t o provide

a minimum o f b a c k g r o u n d i n f o r m a t i o n . As t h e d i s c u s s i o n p r o c e e d s

I s h a l l present a fuller p i c t u r e of v i l l a g e l i f e . Theoretically,

i n d i s c u s s i n g t h e changes w h i c h have o c c u r r e d and are o c c u r r i n g

I should d e s c r i b e the 'classical' or 'traditional\ s t a t e of

a f f a i r s i n the v i l l a g e . S i g n i f i c a n t changes were a l r e a d y t a k i n g

p l a c e i n I n d i a by t h e m i d d l e o f t h e 19th century because of the

pervasive B r i t i s h influence. The s t u d i e s done b e f o r e 1900 were

c o n c e r n e d w i t h d e s c r i b i n g f o o d , d r e s s , and u t e n s i l s , r a t h e r than

social relationships. The primary concern of t h i s paper i s

what w i l l happen g i v e n the p r e s e n t interaction pattern.

In the f o l l o w i n g chapters I s h a l l discuss four analytical

structures: r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n , s o l i d a r i t y , economic alloca-

t i o n , and p o l i t i c a l allocation. These f o u r c h a p t e r s should

give a f a i r l y complete view of the present p a t t e r n s of social

i n t e r a c t i o n i n the v i l l a g e . The l a s t c h a p t e r w i l l be devoted

to a d i s c u s s i o n about w h i c h o f t h e s e a n a l y t i c a l s t r u c t u r e s i s

c h a n g i n g and i n w h i c h d i r e c t i o n t h e change I s t a k i n g p l a c e .
18

FOOTNOTES

"'"Andre B e t e i l e , C a s t e , ' C l a s s a n d Po'w'er ( M a n c h e s t e r , 1965),


p . 9.
R a l p h W. N i c h o l a s , " S t r u c t u r e s o f P o l i t i c s - t h e V i l l a g e s
o f S o u t h e r n A s i a , " S t r u c t u r e ' 'and 'Change - I n d i a n S o c i e t y , e d .
M. S i n g e r a n d B . S . C o h n ( C h i c a g o , 1968).
. . . .

K r a v e , 1953: 119 ( w i t h r e f e r e n c e t o a s i n g l e c a s t e b u t
may a p p l y t o o t h e r s a s w e l l ) ; L e w i s , 1958: l 6 0 - l 6 l ; C o h n , 1954
12; M a y e r , i 9 6 0 : 208, 213.
4
S t a t i s t i c a l Abstract of the Indian Union, C e n t r a l S t a t i s -
t i c a l O r g a n i z a t i o n , D e p t . o f S t a t i s t i c s , Government o f I n d i a
(New D e l h i ) , New S e r i e s , #10.
5
E x a m p l e s o f some d i f f e r e n c e s i n c l u d e : 1) l a c k o f ' s k y
s c r a p e r s ' g e n e r a l l y a s s o c i a t e d w i t h l a r g e r c i t i e s i n t h e West;
2) many more h o m e l e s s r e s i d e n t s l i v i n g w i t h i n t h e c i t y t h a n i s
t h e c a s e , s a y , i n t h e U . S.; 3) l e s s w e l l d e v e l o p e d s u b u r b s ;
4) f a s t e r e x p a n s i o n o f p o p u l a t i o n t h a n i n t h e W e s t j 5) r a p i d
t r a n s i t i o n f r o m u r b a n t o r u r a l a p p e a r a n c e ' s ; 6) v e r y p o o r l y
d e v e l o p e d w a t e r , s a n i t a t i o n , and t r a n s p o r t a t i o n s e r v i c e s .
^ S t a t i s t i c a l A b s t r a c t . . . , op cit

7I b i d ,

Ibid.
9 !
L e w i s , 1958, p . I b b e t s o n , 1883, p . 4; Wood a n d
M a c n a c h i , 1882, p . 19-
10 L e w i s , 1958, p. 8.
11.M i n e r a l r e s o u r c e s :
Known R e s e r v e s
Bauxite 30,000,000 t o n s
Coal 60,960,000,000 t o n s
Copper 3,266,000,000 t o n s
Gold 530,298 t o n s
Gypsum 47,641,000,000 t o n s
Iron ore 21,300,000,000 t o n s
Lead ore
Lignite 130,000,000 t o n s
Limestone S e v e r a l t h o u s a n d m i l l i o n tons.
Manganese O v e r 100 m i l l i o n t o n s
Mica Ample r e s e r v e s
Sulphur 156,000,000 t o n s
19

Economic H i s t o r y o f I n d i a , ed. U. B. S i n g h (New D e l h i ,


1 9 6 5 ) , PP. 4 0 - 5 B . . .
Known r e s e r v e s
Petroleum At l e a s t 100 m i l l i o n t o n s
N a t u r a l Gas At l e a s t 43 m i l l i o n t o n s
I n d i a 1964, I n f o r m a t i o n S e r v i c e o f I n d i a (London, 1 9 6 4 ) .
12
P o t e n t i a l k i l o w a t t p r o d u c t i o n i s 216,000,000 k i l o w a t t
h o u r s ; a c t u a l p r o d u c t i o n i s 12.5 m i l l i o n . T o i d . , p. 31.
13
A l b e r t M a y e r , P i l o t P r o j e c t ; ' I n d i a , 1959; Kusam N a i r ,
Blossoms i n t h e D u s t (New Y o r k , 1 9 6 2 ) .
14 ^
Demographic Yearbook: 1956, S t a t i s t i c a l O f f i c e o f t h e
U n i t e d N a t i o n s , D e p t . o f Economic and S o c i a l A f f a i r s (New Y o r k ,
1 9 5 6 ) , p. 275.
15
S t a t i s t i c a l A b s t r a c t o f t h e I n d i a n U n i o n 19&"0, C e n t r a l
S t a t i s t i c a l O r g a n i z a t i o n , Cabinet O r g a n i z a t i o n , Govt, of I n d i a ,
(New D e l h i ) , New S e r i e s #9 •
x
^ T h e s e r i o t s a r e ones i n w h i c h one p r o t a g o n i s t was t h e
H i n d u community and t h e o t h e r t h e M u s l i m community. They were
e x t r e m e l y d i f f i c u l t t o c o n t r o l b e c a u s e t h e y were so s u d d e n l y
t r i g g e r e d and b e c a u s e s u c h huge numbers o f i n d i v i d u a l s were
involved.
17
P e r s o n a l Communication w i t h a P u n j a b i l a n g u a g e I n s t r u c t o r
at t h e U n i v e r s i t y o f M i n n e s o t a i n t h e summer o f 1963.
18
Myron W e i n e r , P a r t i e s i n I n d i a n P o l i t i c s , ( P r i n c e t o n ,
New J e r s e y , 1 9 5 7 ) , p. 20.
19
N i c h o l a s , op_. c i t . , p. 254.
20 , . ,
T
Ibid.
21
The l a r g e r v i l l a g e s t e n d t o become m a r k e t s i t e s w h i c h
means t h a t t h e y w i l l have more c o n t a c t w i t h b o t h t h e o u t s i d e
w o r l d and w i t h the s u r r o u n d i n g v i l l a g e s t h a n w o u l d t h e t y p i c a l
village.
22
L e w i s , p. 10.
23
I n some v i l l a g e s t h e o u t c a s t e p o p u l a t i o n may a c t u a l l y
r e s i d e a few hundred f e e t f r o m t h e main s e t t l e m e n t . This i s
p r o b a b l y more common i n t h e s o u t h o f I n d i a t h a n anywhere e l s e
because t h e r e seems t o be a l a r g e r p o r t i o n o f t h e p o p u l a t i o n
who are e i t h e r v e r y h i g h c a s t e o r v e r y low c a s t e .
24
Ghee i s c l a r i f i e d b u t t e r and i s much d e s i r e d f o r c o o k i n g
pv uir rle pl oa sgr ea st i.seems
o n .I n tf oa c tbe one
t h e o famount
the measures
o f ghee aofv a ri ellaabtliev ef o wre ause
l t h I nI n f ot oh ed
CHAPTER I I

Role D i f f e r e n t i a t i o n Within the V i l l a g e

. . . the analytic structure of role d i f f e r e n t i a -


t i o n i n any s o c i a l s y s t e m may be d e f i n e d as t h e s t r u c -
t u r e s o f d i s t r i b u t i o n o f t h e members o f t h e s y s t e m among
the v a r i o u s p o s i t i o n s and a c t i v i t i e s d i s t i n g u i s h e d i n
the s y s t e m and hence t h e d i f f e r e n t i a l arrangement o f
the members o f t h e s y s t e m . 1

In order t o a r r i v e a t how a p a r t i c u l a r society goes about

allocating " t h e v a r i o u s p o s i t i o n s and a c t i v i t i e s d i s t i n g u i s h e d "

Levy p r o p o s e s n i n e d i f f e r e n t criteria: age, g e n e r a t i o n , s e x ,

economic a l l o c a t i o n , p o l i t i c a l a l l o c a t i o n , r e l i g i o n , cognition,

nonhuman e n v i r o n m e n t , and s o l i d a r i t y . Not a l l o f t h e s e a r e

significant indicators f o ra l l societies. I n some societies,

f o r example, t h e r e may n o t n e c e s s a r i l y be any r o l e differentia-

t i o n on t h e b a s i s o f r e l i g i o n , nonhuman e n v i r o n m e n t o r c o g n i t i o n .

L e v y h i m s e l f uses o n l y t h e f i r s t f i v e i n h i s discussion of the


2
f a m i l y i n " t r a d i t i o n a l " and " t r a n s i t i o n a l " C h i n a .

While a g r e e i n g w i t h Levy t h a t r o l e s must be differentiated,

I would argue t h a t t h e n i n e c r i t e r i a w h i c h L e v y o u t l i n e s as

minimal f o r d i s c o v e r i n g the nature of the s t r u c t u r e of r o l e

d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n i n a s o c i a l system are inadequate f o r t h e

analysis of the Indian v i l l a g e . I t does n o t seem t h a t their

use s h o u l d a l l o w me t o show how c e r t a i n individuals come t o

fill particular roles within the v i l l a g e . I would h y p o t h e s i z e ,

rather, that roles are d i f f e r e n t i a t e d and a l l o c a t e d i n the

I n d i a n v i l l a g e on t h e b a s i s o f b u t two c a t e g o r i e s o f c r i t e r i a ,

one o f w h i c h i n c l u d e s t h r e e o f t h e c r i t e r i a s u g g e s t e d by L e v y .

20
21

In the f i r s t c a t e g o r y we s h a l l he c o n c e r n e d n o t about i n d i v i d -

u a l s but households. An i n d i v i d u a l assumes a r o l e i n t h e vil-

l a g e on t h e b a s i s o f t h e s t a t u s o f h i s h o u s e h o l d . How one

d e t e r m i n e s t h e s t a t u s o f a p a r t i c u l a r h o u s e h o l d w i l l be dis-

cussed l a t e r i n the c h a p t e r , but s u f f i c e I t t o say t h a t role

a s s u m p t i o n by an i n d i v i d u a l i s o n l y I n d i r e c t l y r e l a t e d to either

a s c r i b e d or achieved c h a r a c t e r i s t i c s . The second c a t e g o r y i s

concerned w i t h the c h a r a c t e r i s t i c s , mainly a s c r i b e d character-

i s t i c s , o f t h e i n d i v i d u a l h i m s e l f s u c h t h a t he does o r does

n o t assume a p a r t i c u l a r r o l e w i t h i n t h e h o u s e h o l d . I shall

consider three c h a r a c t e r i s t i c s : age, s e x , and g e n e r a t i o n .

They a r e t h e most u s e f u l f o r d e t e r m i n i n g t h e s t r u c t u r e of

r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n w i t h i n the household.

An i n d i v i d u a l ' s r o l e i n v i l l a g e a c t i v i t i e s i s determined

f i r s t by h i s r o l e I n h o u s e h o l d a c t i v i t i e s and s e c o n d (and more

i m p o r t a n t l y ) by t h e p o s i t i o n of h i s household r e l a t i v e t o other

households In the v i l l a g e . The i n d i v i d u a l must become p a r t o f

the d e c i s i o n - m a k i n g machinery o f t h e h o u s e h o l d b e f o r e he can

b e g i n t o t h i n k of assuming a p a r t i n the d e c i s i o n - m a k i n g

machinery of the v i l l a g e . Achieved c h a r a c t e r i s t i c s become

i m p o r t a n t o n l y when two i n d i v i d u a l s have t h e same a s c r i b e d

characteristics and t h e i r h o u s e h o l d s t a t u s i s r o u g h l y t h e same.3

ROLE DIFFERENTIATION WITHIN THE HOUSEHOLD^

Before d i s c u s s i n g r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n w i t h i n the household

i n terms o f t h e t h r e e c r i t e r i a m e n t i o n e d above ( a g e , g e n e r a t i o n ,

and s e x ) i t I s n e c e s s a r y t h a t some c o n s i d e r a t i o n be d e v o t e d t o a
22

d e f i n i t i o n of "household." I n the v i l l a g e the adult i s not

r e a l l y c o n s i d e r e d a whole p e r s o n u n t i l he i s m a r r i e d and

rearing children. Those who a r e n o t m a r r i e d and t h o s e who

a r e m a r r i e d b u t w i t h o u t c h i l d r e n a r e o b j e c t s o f p i t y a n d , as

S r i n i v a s p o i n t s o u t , t o be a v o i d e d by some g r o u p s , "Brahmin

beggars who a r e supposed t o be v e r y o r t h o d o x do n o t t a k e alms


5
from t h e c h i l d l e s s . . .' P r i m a r y emphasis i s p l a c e d on m a l e

c h i l d r e n because t h e e l d e s t male c h i l d i s r e s p o n s i b l e f o r see-

i n g t h a t h i s f a t h e r and m o t h e r , b u t p r i m a r i l y t h e f a t h e r , become

p r o p e r a n c e s t o r s , and b e c a u s e t h e m a l e p r o g e n y a r e a s o u r c e o f

s u p p o r t i n t h e i r p a r e n t s ' o l d age. Female c h i l d r e n a r e o f l e s s


6

importance f o r the household because they t y p i c a l l y pass out

of the household a t an e a r l y age and i n t o t h e h o u s e h o l d I n

w h i c h t h e husband r e s i d e s — n e a r l y a l w a y s I n another village

and o f t e n a c o n s i d e r a b l e d i s t a n c e away. B a r e l y do t h e f e m a l e s

become o l d enough t o be p r o d u c i n g members t h a n t h e y a r e m a r r i e d

i n t o another household. Not o n l y do t h e y l e a v e , b u t t h e y t a k e

a s i z a b l e dowry w i t h them.
DEFINITION OP HOUSEHOLD
The i d e a l household i n northcentral India i s the j o i n t

household i n which three generations l i v e t o g e t h e r w i t h t h e i r

w i v e s and c h i l d r e n under one r o o f s h a r i n g a s i n g l e h e a r t h .

The j o i n t h o u s e h o l d i s b e g i n n i n g t o l o s e i t s " j o i n t n e s s " when

m u l t i p l e h e a r t h s a r e employed. There seems t o be a d e f i n i t e

p a t h down w h i c h j o i n t h o u s e h o l d s t r a v e l towards splitting:


23

first, separate h e a r t h s ; second, p a r t i t i o n s w i t h i n the house;

t h i r d , s e p a r a t e h o u s e s ; and f o u r t h , s p l i t t i n g up t h e l a n d among

the h e i r s . F r i e n d s and a s s o c i a t e s work h a r d t o p r e v e n t the

b r e a k up b u t n o r m a l l y s u c c e e d o n l y i n s l o w i n g down t h e process.

Only v e r y r a r e l y are f o u r g e n e r a t i o n s f o u n d l i v i n g t o g e t h e r .

Indeed, a three-generation household i s n o t common and t h e n may

last o n l y f o r a v e r y few y e a r s b e c a u s e o f t h e s h o r t l i f e expec-

tancy. T h i s i s p o i n t e d out by C o l l v e r i n h i s c o m p a r i s o n of the

f a m i l y c y c l e i n I n d i a and t h e U n i t e d S t a t e s . The death of one

of t h e p a r e n t s f r e q u e n t l y o c c u r s b e f o r e t h e m a r r i a g e of the

eldest child i n India. Thus t h e j o i n t h o u s e h o l d i s more likely

t o be t w o - g e n e r a t i o n a l c o n s i s t i n g o f a group o f male siblings,

t h e i r wives and c h i l d r e n . Being part of a j o i n t household would

seem t o be t h e i d e a l s t a t e o f c o n d i t i o n r a t h e r t h a n something

w h i c h e x i s t s i n t h e r e a l w o r l d t o any d e g r e e . There are too

many f a c t o r s i n v o l v e d w h i c h tend to m i t i g a t e the possibility

of a c h i e v i n g and m a i n t a i n i n g a j o i n t h o u s e h o l d . J o i n t house-

h o l d s a r e most numerous i n t h e w e a l t h i e r c a s t e s and become l e s s

f r e q u e n t w i t h t h e d e c r e a s i n g s t a t u s and w e a l t h o f t h e c a s t e

group. Only t h o s e h o u s e h o l d s which possess a large resource

b a s e — u n t i l r e c e n t l y ownership of l a n d i n the village—can

a f f o r d to maintain a s i z a b l e household. Even p o s s e s s i o n o f

w e a l t h does not mean t h a t t h e y a r e l i k e l y t o r e m a i n f o r v e r y

l o n g as a j o i n t h o u s e h o l d as we s h a l l see l a t e r . I n Oscar

L e w i s ' Rampur s t u d y o n l y t h i r t e e n out o f 150 households con-

t a i n e d more t h a n t w e l v e members and a l l o f t h e s e households


24

were e i t h e r J a t i s o r Brahmins who e i t h e r owned a c o n s i d e r a b l e

amount o f l a n d o r had good j o b s o u t s i d e o f t h e v i l l a g e . Among

the l e s s w e l l - o f f c a s t e s o n l y one h o u s e h o l d out o f a t o t a l of

55 had more t h a n n i n e members. Average h o u s e h o l d s i z e varies

f r o m 8.3 f o r t h e J a t i s who are the w e a l t h i e s t caste i n the

v i l l a g e t o 5.0 f o r t h e Chamars ( a l o w c a s t e g r o u p s r i t u a l l y and

one w i t h l i t t l e w e a l t h i n e i t h e r l a n d o r o u t s i d e j o b s ) . ^ On

the b a s i s o f h o u s e h o l d s i z e , i t w o u l d seem t h a t t h e s i n g l e most

common t y p e o f h o u s e h o l d i s t h e stem h o u s e h o l d — t h a t i s , one,

and i n f r e q u e n t l y b o t h , o f t h e aged p a r e n t s o f t h e head o f t h e

h o u s e h o l d and sometimes an u n m a r r i e d s i s t e r o r b r o t h e r . Most

of the d i s c u s s i o n which f o l l o w s i s d i r e c t e d toward the l a r g e

h o u s e h o l d and may i n f a c t be an idealization.

AGE AS THE BASIS OF ROLE DIFFERENTIATION WITHIN THE HOUSEHOLD

As might be e x p e c t e d a b s o l u t e age has a g r e a t d e a l t o do

with role selection. I d e a l l y t h e e l d e s t male i n t h e h o u s e h o l d

i s t h e f i n a l a u t h o r i t y on a l l m a t t e r s h a v i n g t o do w i t h t h e

maintenance of the household. Obedience I s e x p e c t e d t o be

prompt and c o m p l e t e . The h o u s e h o l d head makes t h e decisions

and sees t h a t t h e y a r e i m p l e m e n t e d . In a c t u a l f a c t the house-

h o l d r e l a t i o n s h i p s are never t h a t e x a c t . There a l w a y s seem

t o be m i t i g a t i n g c i r c u m s t a n c e s . The d e c i s i o n s made by t h e

head o f t h e h o u s e h o l d a r e n e v e r made I n a vacuum. A 'good'

h o u s e h o l d head t a k e s i n t o c o n s i d e r a t i o n t h e o t h e r members o f

the household. As I p o i n t e d out above t h e head o f h o u s e h o l d


25

may have l i v i n g w i t h h i m h i s aged f a t h e r . According t o the

i d e a l t h e aged f a t h e r i s t h e head o f t h e h o u s e h o l d , b u t t h e

r e a l i t y o f t h e s i t u a t i o n i s t h a t t h e aged f a t h e r exercises

very little authority. He i s o n l y t h e t i t u l a r head o f h o u s e -

h o l d , n o t t h e de f a c t o h e a d . The a u t h o r i t y o f t h e male b e g i n s

t o wane when he no l o n g e r can p r o v i d e the bulk of the f i n a n c i a l

resources necessary t o maintain the household. As w e l l , h i s

i n t e l l e c t u a l c a p a c i t y t o make d e c i s i o n s may be a f f e c t e d should

he be f o r t u n a t e enough t o l i v e t h a t l o n g . U s u a l l y what happens

i s t h a t t h e son simply leaves s o o n a f t e r m a r r i a g e i f he cannot

get a l o n g w i t h h i s f a t h e r . 1 0

I d e a l l y t h e h o u s e h o l d head has c o m p l e t e a u t h o r i t y t o make

any and a l l d e c i s i o n s about h o u s e h o l d m a t t e r s . In r e a l i t y the

male assumes more and more i m p o r t a n c e as he m a r r i e s and has

c h i l d r e n , and t a k e s a f u l l p a r t i n p r o v i d i n g t h e h o u s e h o l d t h e

wherewithal to e x i s t . The n e w l y m a r r i e d s o n does n o t need t o

be consulted about h o u s e h o l d d e c i s i o n s , b u t t h e w i s e father

c o n s u l t s him i n order t o keep t h e s o n s a t i s f i e d a n d , p e r h a p s

more i m p o r t a n t l y , t o provide the son w i t h experience i n d e a l i n g

w i t h ' the v a r i o u s f a c t o r s i n v o l v e d I n making d e c i s i o n s . I f there

i s more t h a n one s o n , t h e o t h e r sons w i l l n o t l i k e l y be as

i n v o l v e d f o r i t i s t h e e l d e s t son who w i l l look a f t e r the

p a r e n t s and c a r r y o u t t h e p r o p e r r i t u a l s w h i c h w i l l a l l o w t h e

p a r e n t s t o become pukah a n c e s t o r s . A l w a y s t h e d e c i s i o n must

be obeyed, b u t h a v i n g had a hand i n t h e p r o c e s s o f a r r i v i n g a t

a d e c i s i o n , t h e son's o b e d i e n c e comes e a s i e r .
26

On t h e f e m a l e s i d e , age h a s a g r e a t d e a l t o do w i t h posi-

t i o n i n the decision-making machinery. I d e a l l y o f course

f e m a l e s have no p o s i t i o n o f a u t h o r i t y i n t h e p a t r i a r c h i c a l

Indian household. N o n e t h e l e s s f e m a l e s do e x e r t c o n s i d e r a b l e

influence. I n t h e h o u s e h o l d o f o r i g i n t h e y have v i r t u a l l y no

i n f l u e n c e because t h e y pass o u t o f t h a t h o u s e h o l d a t a young

age. However, i n t h e h o u s e h o l d w h i c h t h e y j o i n upon m a r r i a g e

I t i s p o s s i b l e t o come t o a p o s i t i o n o f i n f l u e n c e as t h e y

i n c r e a s e i n age ( t h e m o t h e r - i n - l a w I s a p o w e r f u l f o r c e within

the family).

As a young b r i d e a f e m a l e c l e a r l y has no i n f l u e n c e because

she I s c o m p l e t e l y under t h e thumb o f h e r m o t h e r - i n - l a w . The

p a r e n t s make t h e d e c i s i o n s , n o t h e r h u s b a n d — t h i s i n c l u d e s t h e

d e c i s i o n as t o who w i l l be h e r husband. The b r i d e must satisfy

h e r husband's p a r e n t s , n o t h e r h u s b a n d . She has no a u t h o r i t y

whatsoever. Her r e a s o n f o r e x i s t e n c e i s t o p r o v i d e h e r husband

w i t h c h i l d r e n and u n t i l she h a s them she c a n be t r e a t e d as

though she d o e s n ' t e x i s t . With the a r r i v a l of c h i l d r e n

( p a r t i c u l a r l y a male c h i l d ) h e r t r e a t m e n t a t t h e hands o f h e r

new r e l a t i v e s i m p r o v e s . She c a n make c l a i m s f o r b e t t e r treat-

ment (more f o o d , b e t t e r c l o t h i n g ) , i f n o t f o r h e r s e l f , a t

l e a s t f o r the c h i l d r e n . As t h e m o t h e r - i n - l a w g e t s o l d e r , and

more f e e b l e , t h e w i f e b e g i n s t o 'take up t h e s l a c k . ' The a r e n a

o f a u t h o r i t y f o r women c o n s i s t s i n m a i n t a i n i n g o r d e r w i t h i n t h e

household. The woman h a s t o see t h a t a c t i v i t i e s a r e so a r r a n g e d

t h a t t h e needs o f t h e husband a r e met. She i s r e s p o n s i b l e t o


27

the husband and any r e a l l y i m p o r t a n t d e c i s i o n s a r e made i n

his name. By t h i s t i m e t h e husband and w i f e who b e f o r e mar-

r i a g e were s t r a n g e r s have a r r i v e d a t some k i n d o f r e l a t i o n s h i p


11
w h i c h e n a b l e s them t o f u n c t i o n f a i r l y s m o o t h l y as a h o u s e h o l d .

The p e r i o d o f g r e a t e s t i n f l u e n c e comes t o t h e woman when

she a c h i e v e s t h e p o s i t i o n o f m o t h e r - i n - l a w . She now has a

young d a u g h t e r - i n - l a w t o mold so t h a t she w i l l be a f i t w i f e

for her son. She has c o m p l e t e c o n t r o l o v e r a l l i n t e r n a l house-

hold matters. She may even have i n f l u e n c e o v e r r e l a t i o n s h i p s

w h i c h have d e v e l o p e d between t h e h o u s e h o l d and o t h e r h o u s e -

holds i n the v i l l a g e . T h i s r o l e w i l l be d i s c u s s e d more fully

when I t a l k about t h e s o l i d a r i t y s t r u c t u r e s i n t h e n e x t c h a p t e r .

In the p r e c e d i n g paragraphs I have d i s c u s s e d t h e e f f e c t of

a b s o l u t e age on t h e m a k i n g o f d e c i s i o n s . In c e r t a i n situations

r e l a t i v e age i s I m p o r t a n t — p r i m a r i l y when male s i b l i n g s are

concerned. R e l a t i v e age i s a l w a y s i m p o r t a n t i n s u c h e v e n t s

as h o u s e h o l d c o u n c i l s ( i f such a t h i n g i s h e l d ) , b u t t h e r e

are two o t h e r p e r i o d s when r e l a t i v e age I s p a r t i c u l a r l y crucial.

The f i r s t i s In childhood. D u r i n g c h i l d h o o d o l d e r c h i l d r e n are

o f t e n r e s p o n s i b l e f o r t h e i r younger siblings—particularly In

p o o r e r h o u s e h o l d s t h a t cannot a f f o r d t o r e t a i n a n u r s e o r do

n o t have g r a n d p a r e n t s about t o do t h e j o b . V a r y i n g amounts

of t h e t r a i n i n g o f younger c h i l d r e n a r e c a r r i e d out by t h e

o l d e r c h i l d r e n i n whose charge t h e y a r e p l a c e d d u r i n g a good

p a r t o f t h e day. The amount depends upon age and sex o f b o t h

the o l d e r c h i l d r e n and t h e younger.


28

The second o c c a s i o n i n which r e l a t i v e age i s important i s

after t h e d e a t h of t h e f a t h e r when t h e group o f b r o t h e r s con-

t i n u e s t o o p e r a t e as a j o i n t h o u s e h o l d . In t h i s s i t u a t i o n the

eldest brother i s the one t h r o u g h whose mouth d e c i s i o n s emanate.

As t h e e l d e s t he makes d e c i s i o n s f o r t h e g r o u p . That t h e r e must

be o t h e r b a s e s f o r t h e m a i n t e n a n c e o f power and authority than

t h a t of r e l a t i v e age i s e v i d e n c e d by t h e s h o r t - l i v e d nature of

j o i n t h o u s e h o l d s composed o f b r o t h e r s . The eldest brother takes

the p l a c e of the f a t h e r w i t h o u t h a v i n g the same i n s t i t u t i o n a l i z e d

bases f o r t h i s p o s i t i o n as d i d h i s f a t h e r . Often brothers may

f i n d i t p o s s i b l e to operate w i t h the e l d e s t b r o t h e r as t h e house-

h o l d head, but the wives of the b r o t h e r s f o r c e the separation.

The w i v e s o f t e n do not have t h e m u t u a l t i e s of a f f e c t i o n that

e x i s t between b r o t h e r s and f r e q u e n t l y q u a r r e l among t h e m s e l v e s .

T h i s i s not t o say that brothers a l w a y s get a l o n g , b e c a u s e t h e y

do n o t , n o r i s i t t o say t h a t w i v e s c a n n o t g e t a l o n g , because

i n some c a s e s t h e y do. I have no s t a t i s t i c s , but i t would

seem t h a t w i v e s a r e more f r e q u e n t l y t h e cause o f j o i n t h o u s e h o l d


12
disintegration t h a n are b r o t h e r s . Perhaps t h e b a s i c reason

f o r t h e q u a r r e l s between w i v e s i s t h a t t h e s e n i o r w i f e (wife of

the e l d e s t b r o t h e r ) assumes t h e r o l e o f h o u s e h o l d manager w h i c h

was p r e v i o u s l y o c c u p i e d by t h e m o t h e r - i n - l a w w i t h o u t t h e genera-

t i o n a l prerogatives of the mother-in-law. The other wives are

quick to resent t h i s and j u s t as q u i c k l y work on t h e i r respective

husbands t o s e t up s e p a r a t e h o u s e h o l d s so t h a t t h e y can do their

own managing w i t h o u t I n t e r f e r e n c e from other wives. I n some


29

cases t h e b r o t h e r s m a i n t a i n t h e h o u s e h o l d p r o p e r t y as a s i n g l e

u n i t , b u t s e t up s e p a r a t e living quarters.

Prom t h e above I c a n c o n c l u d e t h a t r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n on

t h e b a s i s o f r e l a t i v e age must r e i n f o r c e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n on t h e

b a s i s o f a b s o l u t e age. Obviously t h e two a r e c l o s e l y t i e d and

any c o n t r a d i c t i o n s between t h e two b a s e s c a n o n l y l e a d t o

instability o f the system. R e l a t i v e age by I t s e l f i s o n l y a

v e r y weak b a s i s f o r a u t h o r i t y .

ROLE DIFFERENTIATION ON THE BASIS OF GENERATION

R o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n on t h e b a s i s o f g e n e r a t i o n I s o b v i o u s l y

t i e d i n w i t h age. I n some r e s p e c t s g e n e r a t i o n i s s i m i l a r t o

the c a t e g o r y o f r e l a t i v e age. One c a n n o t p l a c e d e f i n i t e limits

o f age on g e n e r a t i o n a l c a t e g o r i e s . Generation here r e f e r s t o

a p e r s o n ' s p o s i t i o n r e l a t i v e t o o t h e r i n d i v i d u a l s who l i e e i t h e r

above o r below h i m on t h e b i o l o g i c a l , o r p u t a t i v e l y b i o l o g i c a l ,

descent T i n e . Thus t h e f a t h e r and h i s b r o t h e r s a r e o f a d i f -

f e r e n t g e n e r a t i o n t h a n t h e f a t h e r ' s s o n . The f a t h e r ' s youngest

b r o t h e r may be y o u n g e r t h a n h i s o l d e s t s o n so t h a t one may

o c c a s i o n a l l y see t h e i n c o n g r u o u s situation ( t o u s ) o f an o l d e r

man t r e a t i n g a y o u n g e r man w i t h t h e same r e s p e c t as he w o u l d

h i s own f a t h e r . This i s of course f a r from the normal situation

and i f i t were I t would l e a d t o i n s t a b i l i t y of t h e system because

it i s i n c o n t r a d i c t i o n t o t h e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n o f r o l e s on t h e

b a s i s o f age. Under n o r m a l c i r c u m s t a n c e s there i s a d e f i n i t e

gap between t h e members o f one g e n e r a t i o n and t h e n e x t . The

f i r s t ascending g e n e r a t i o n i s u s u a l l y t h e g e n e r a t i o n w h i c h has
30

t h e c a p a b i l i t y and r e s p o n s i b i l i t y f o r r e a r i n g t h e f o l l o w i n g

generation. I t i s p r i m a r i l y t h e husband and w i f e who manage

t h e c a r e and u p b r i n g i n g o f t h e c h i l d r e n . I n most c a s e s this

i s b e c a u s e t h e r e a r e o n l y t h e husband and w i f e as a d u l t s i n

the household.
13
I have no i n f o r m a t i o n concerning the r e l a t i o n s h i p between
a l t e r n a t e g e n e r a t i o n s , b u t one may assume t h a t i t i s d i f f e r e n t
14
than t h a t of t h e p a r e n t - c h i l d r e l a t i o n s h i p . The grandparents

probably do n o t have r e s p o n s i b i l i t y i n t h e same manner as t h e

parents. They a r e l e s s d i r e c t l y concerned w i t h t r a i n i n g the

g r a n d c h i l d r e n and hence t h e r e a r e more p o s s i b i l i t i e s f o r ties

of a f f e c t i o n t o develop. G r a n d p a r e n t s and g r a n d c h i l d r e n may

see t h e m s e l v e s as a l l i e s . Grandparents are l o s i n g previous

a u t h o r i t y and t h e g r a n d c h i l d r e n have none. Each i s s u b o r d i n a t e

t o t h e g e n e r a t i o n between. I suspect that parents make use o f

grandparents as p a r e n t subrogates o n l y when a b s o l u t e l y necessary

b e c a u s e t h e r e i s n o t t h e c l e a r d i c h o t o m y between s u b o r d i n a t e and

s u p e r o r d i n a t e as t h e r e i s i n t h e p a r e n t - c h i l d r e l a t i o n s h i p .

Although i t i s t h e p a r e n t s who a r e r e s p o n s i b l e f o r r a i s i n g t h e

c h i l d , i t i s the grandparents who a r e t h e s o u r c e o f much o f

the c u l t u r a l h i s t o r y w h i c h e v e r y o n e i s e x p e c t e d t o know b e c a u s e

t h e y a r e t h e group w h i c h has t h e t i m e t o do s o . The f a t h e r and

mother a r e t o o b u s y as p r o d u c e r s to t a l k with the c h i l d r e n . In

any e v e n t , t h i s i s o f t e n n o t a c r u c i a l i s s u e b e c a u s e t h e r e a r e

o n l y a few h o u s e h o l d s w h i c h have I n c l u d e d i n t h e i r members a

grandparent. Most o f t e n , i n p o o r e r h o u s e h o l d s , younger c h i l d r e n


31

are c a r e d f o r by o l d e r c h i l d r e n o r c h i l d r e n t a g a l o n g w i t h their

parents as t h e y go about t h e i r d a i l y tasks.

I n t h e I n d i a n v i l l a g e g e n e r a t i o n a l d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n , and

t h e s u b s e q u e n t b e h a v i o u r p a t t e r n s , a r e e x t e n d e d beyond t h e

immediate k i n s h i p g r o u p . The f a t h e r ' s age mates w i t h i n t h e

l o c a l c a s t e group a r e t r e a t e d w i t h r e s p e c t similar t o that

given the f a t h e r . Generational d i f f e r e n c e s are observed

between c a s t e s as w e l l . The f u r t h e r away b i o l o g i c a l l y t h e

g e n e r a t i o n a l l y o l d e r man I s , t h e l e s s he w i l l be t r e a t e d i n

the same manner as t h e y o u n g e r man w o u l d t r e a t h i s f a t h e r .

ROLE DIFFERENTIATION ON THE BASIS OF SEX

R o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n on t h e b a s i s o f s e x i s n o t , i n some

i n s t a n c e s , as c l e a r c u t as r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n on t h e b a s i s

o f age. The p r i m a r y d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n i s s t r i c t l y biological

i n nature. Women b e a r t h e c h i l d r e n and d u r i n g t h e e a r l y y e a r s

of t h e c h i l d ' s l i f e are v i r t u a l l y the only sex with which the

c h i l d h a s any i n t e r a c t i o n r e g a r d l e s s o f i t s sex. By and l a r g e

it c a n be s a i d t h a t t h e women a r e r e s p o n s i b l e f o r t h e p r e p a r a -

t i o n o f f o o d and t h e m a i n t e n a n c e o f c l o t h i n g . Beyond t h e s e

few t h i n g s t h e r o l e s p l a y e d by a d u l t s I n t h e h o u s e h o l d depend

upon c a s t e membership and t h e l e v e l o f w e a l t h . Many o f t h e j o b s

n e c e s s a r y f o r t h e m a i n t e n a n c e o f t h e h o u s e h o l d c a n be done by

e i t h e r men o r women and a r e o f t e n done by b o t h w o r k i n g together.

There a r e v e r y few j o b s w h i c h r e q u i r e s h e e r b r u t e strength.

R o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n I s on t h e b a s i s o f what i s t h o u g h t t o be

appropriate and t h i s v a r i e s from c a s t e t o c a s t e and on t h e

wealth of the household.


32

The women o f w e a l t h y , h i g h c a s t e h o u s e h o l d s do v e r y little

a c t u a l p h y s i c a l l a b o u r even i n terms o f r a i s i n g t h e i r own

children. Those h o u s e h o l d s c a n a f f o r d t o r e t a i n o t h e r s t o do

t h e housework and t h e w i v e s a r e m e r e l y a d m i n i s t r a t o r s and

managers. Females are concerned p r i m a r i l y w i t h the i n t e r n a l

a f f a i r s of the household. The r e l a t i o n s h i p s w h i c h t h e y f o r m

a r e w i t h o t h e r women. Men a r e n o t r e a l l y p a r t o f t h e i r w o r l d .

The o n l y men w i t h whom t h e y i n t e r a c t a r e t h e i r husbands and

sons. The f a t h e r - i n - l a w and t h e e l d e r b r o t h e r s - i n - l a w a r e t o

15

be a v o i d e d . Any r e l a t i o n s h i p s w h i c h e x i s t between h o u s e -

h o l d s a r e m a i n t a i n e d by t h e males o f the household. Females

f r o m one h o u s e h o l d do have o c c a s i o n t o i n t e r a c t w i t h f e m a l e s

o f o t h e r h o u s e h o l d s , b u t t h i s does n o t o c c u r f r e q u e n t l y . One

i n t e r a c t s f r e e l y w i t h e q u a l s o n l y and t h e r e a r e n o t v e r y many

equals i n a s o c i a l system which i s h i g h l y concerned about


r e l a t i v e ranking.

I n t h e s e s o r t s o f w e a l t h y h o u s e h o l d s t h e males a r e i n much

t h e same p o s i t i o n as t h e f e m a l e s . They a r e t h e managers o f

t h e h o u s e h o l d p r o p e r t i e s and o n l y r a r e l y do any p h y s i c a l work.

H i g h c a s t e h o u s e h o l d s w o u l d r a t h e r l e a v e t h e work undone t h a n

do i t t h e m s e l v e s because t h e y w o u l d s u f f e r a l o s s o f p r e s t i g e

were t h e y t o do s o . Generally speaking, i n wealthy households

t h e males form the p r o d u c t i o n u n i t t h a t b r i n g s i n the r e q u i s i t e

income t o m a i n t a i n t h e h o u s e h o l d . This i s accomplished e i t h e r

by managing t h e h o u s e h o l d p r o p e r t y o r by o c c u p y i n g a p o s i t i o n

w h i c h b r i n g s i n income f r o m o u t s i d e t h e v i l l a g e .
33

A c t u a l l y i t i s o n l y i n t h e upper c a s t e o r wealthy house-

h o l d s t h a t t h e r e i s a g r e a t d i s t i n c t i o n between t h e r o l e s o f

men and women--and t h e s e r e p r e s e n t a s m a l l p e r c e n t a g e o f t h e

t o t a l households i n the v i l l a g e . I n t h e low c a s t e h o u s e h o l d s

or h o u s e h o l d s w i t h l o w incomes t h e p o s i t i o n o f b o t h males and

f e m a l e s i s somewhat d i f f e r e n t . I n d i v i d u a l s , b o t h male and

female, a c t n o t i n terms o f what I s d e s i r a b l e b u t what i s n e c e s -

sary. The women a r e o f t e n r e q u i r e d t o perform d u t i e s which

t a k e them o u t o f t h e h o u s e . The women o f t h e l o w e r c a s t e s must

perform f o r t h e women o f t h e u p p e r c a s t e s t h e same s o r t o f

s e r v i c e t h a t t h e i r husbands p e r f o r m f o r t h e husbands o f t h e

upper c a s t e w i v e s . The v i l l a g e washerman washes t h e c l o t h i n g

o f t h e u p p e r c a s t e males and t h e w i f e o f t h e washerman washes

the c l o t h i n g o f t h e u p p e r c a s t e f e m a l e s . The c l o t h i n g i s washed

i n t h e l o c a l s t r e a m o r t a n k s o t h a t t h e j o b c a n n o t be done w i t h i n

t h e home. T h i s b e i n g t h e case f o r a f a i r l y l a r g e number o f c a s t e

occupations t h e f e m a l e c a n spend o n l y a p a r t o f t h e a v a i l a b l e

time c a r r y i n g o u t t h e d u t i e s o f c h i l d c a r e and f o o d prepara-

tion. They a r e i n e f f e c t managers a l t h o u g h they are not

managing s e r v a n t s b u t t h e i r own c h i l d r e n . O f t e n women o f t h e

poorer a g r i c u l t u r a l castes or poorer households o f the higher

a g r i c u l t u r a l c a s t e s must h e l p t h e i r husbands i n t h e f i e l d s dur-

ing t h e c r i s i s p e r i o d s o f p l a n t i n g and h a r v e s t i n g . It is

d e f i n i t e l y c o n s i d e r e d demeaning f o r women o f t h e h i g h caste

h o u s e h o l d t o be seen d o i n g any k i n d of work o u t s i d e o f t h e home.

I t i s n o t c o n s i d e r e d demeaning f o r l o w e r c a s t e women t o work


34

o u t s i d e o f t h e home ( i t i s a c t u a l l y p a r t o f t h e i r r o l e ) so t h a t

t h e r e i s n o t t h e sharp d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n o f r o l e s i n the lower

c a s t e h o u s e h o l d s as t h e r e i s i n t h e h i g h c a s t e household.

The i d e a l r o l e o f women i n t h e I n d i a n h o u s e h o l d seems t o

be s i m i l a r i n some ways t o t h e i d e a l r o l e o f women i n o u r

society. That i s t o s a y t h a t t h e y a r e v i e w e d as consumers

and n o t as p r o d u c e r s . The man who r e q u i r e s t h a t h i s w i f e work

to help support the family i s not r e a l l y f u l f i l l i n g h i s r o l e

as p r o v i d e r . One b i g d i f f e r e n c e between t h e w e a l t h y o f our

s o c i e t y and t h e w e a l t h y of the Indian v i l l a g e i s that i n the

I n d i a n v i l l a g e t h e woman i s n o t e x p e c t e d t o conspicuously

consume.

I d e a l l y o f c o u r s e , t h e r e i s a l w a y s a d i s t i n c t i o n between

male and f e m a l e r o l e s , b u t t o t h e e x t e n t t h a t t h e male must

depend upon t h e h e l p o f h i s w i f e as p r o d u c e r r a t h e r than con-

sumer t h e d i s t i n c t i o n between male and f e m a l e ' r o l e s i s b l u r r e d

I do n o t t h i n k t h e r e c a n h e l p b u t be a c e r t a i n amount o f c o n -

f u s i o n where r o l e d i s t i n c t i o n s a r e n o t c l e a r and t h i s c a n i n

t u r n e f f e c t such t h i n g s as t h e a l l o c a t i o n o f power and

responsibility. The f e m a l e c a n and does e x e r t more a u t h o r i t y

t h a n she I s i d e a l l y allowed.

Age, g e n e r a t i o n , and s e x , t h e n , a r e t h e m a j o r bases f o r t h e

d i s t i n c t i o n s between r o l e s w i t h i n t h e h o u s e h o l d i n t h e I n d i a n

village. I s h o u l d now l i k e t o examine t h e s e c o n d category

mentioned a t t h e f i r s t o f t h e c h a p t e r , t h a t o f household s t a t u s
35

which w i l l a i d i n the d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n of r o l e s w i t h i n the

village social structure.

HOUSEHOLD STATUS AS A MEANS OF ROLE DIFFERENTIATION WITHIN


THE VILLAGE
R o l e s a r e o c c u p i e d w i t h i n t h e v i l l a g e s t r u c t u r e on t h e

basis of household s t a t u s . One must be t h e head o f a h o u s e h o l d

w i t h h i g h s t a t u s b e f o r e i t i s p o s s i b l e t o assume any i m p o r t a n t

r o l e w i t h i n the v i l l a g e . Since at the v i l l a g e l e v e l household

has d i f f e r e n t c o n n o t a t i o n s t h a t i t does a t t h e h o u s e h o l d level

I t h i n k i t i m p o r t a n t t h a t t h e t e r m h o u s e h o l d be p r o p e r l y under-

stood. To t h e i n d i v i d u a l t h e h o u s e h o l d r e f e r s t o t h e group of

p e o p l e who have a common r e s i d e n c e . The p r i m a r y orientation

and l o y a l t y o f e v e r y I n d i v i d u a l i s d i r e c t e d i n w a r d s t o w a r d s the

r e s t of the h o u s e h o l d . ^ 1
At t h e v i l l a g e l e v e l i n d i v i d u a l s see

t h e h o u s e h o l d as t h e b a s i c u n i t out o f w h i c h v i l l a g e social

structure arises. Each i n d i v i d u a l d i s t i n g u i s h e s between r o l e s

w i t h i n h i s own h o u s e h o l d b u t does n o t do so f o r o t h e r h o u s e -

holds . The o n l y s i g n i f i c a n t i n t e r a c t i o n between h o u s e h o l d s i s

t h a t between h o u s e h o l d heads who act f o r t h e i r respective

h o u s e h o l d s as a u n i t . In a d d i t i o n to t h i s d i s t i n c t i o n the

h o u s e h o l d I s seen as a more a l l - i n c l u s i v e u n i t t h a t t h e indi-

v i d u a l perhaps views i t . The h o u s e h o l d u n i t f o r t h e individual

i s t h e group who s h a r e a common h e a r t h . The h o u s e h o l d as seen

by o t h e r s i n t h e v i l l a g e may p e r h a p s be b e t t e r r e f e r r e d t o as

the " k i n d r e d o f c o o p e r a t i o n . " T h i s i s a t e r m w h i c h I have b o r -

rowed f r o m Mayer who uses I t i n h i s d i s c u s s i o n o f c a s t e and kinship


36

i n c e n t r a l I n d i a .17 The k i n d r e d o f c o o p e r a t i o n I s t h a t group

of k i n which cooperates i n matters e c o n o m i c a l , p o l i t i c a l and

religious. They o p e r a t e as a u n i t v i s - a - v i s o t h e r k i n d r e d s .

The minimum s i z e f o r a k i n d r e d i s a s i n g l e h o u s e h o l d and t h e

maximum s i z e i s t h a t number o f h o u s e h o l d s w h i c h c a n s t i l l main-

t a i n a u n i t e d face against other kindreds. E f f o r t s a r e made

t o m a i n t a i n as l a r g e a k i n d r e d o f c o o p e r a t i o n as p o s s i b l e , how-
18
ever, because i t i n c r e a s e s t h e s t a t u s p o t e n t i a l o f t h e k i n d r e d .

In o t h e r words t h e i n d i v i d u a l v i l l a g e r has two c o n c e p t i o n s

of the household. Which one he employs depends upon t h e c i r -

cumstances. I f i t i s an i n d i v i d u a l h o u s e h o l d matter the house-

h o l d i s composed o f t h o s e who s h a r e a common h e a r t h . Ifi t is

a v i l l a g e or caste matter i n d i v i d u a l s w i t h i n the household are

not i m p o r t a n t r a t h e r i t i s t h e h o u s e h o l d as a w h o l e .

Kindred o f c o o p e r a t i o n are always i n t r a c a s t e i n c o m p o s i t i o n .

Each c a s t e group w i t h i n t h e v i l l a g e w i l l t h e n have a t l e a s t one

kindred. The n u m e r i c a l l y s m a l l c a s t e s may be composed o f o n l y

two o r three households, t h e heads o f w h i c h a r e b r o t h e r s , c o u s i n s


19
or even more d i s t a n t r e l a t i v e s , but i f they a c t t o g e t h e r

socially, politically, e c o n o m i c a l l y , and r e l i g i o u s l y t h e y c a n

be c o n s i d e r e d a k i n d r e d . The n u m e r i c a l l y l a r g e r c a s t e s w i l l

more t h a n l i k e l y be composed o f a t l e a s t s e v e r a l k i n d r e d s each


ol
f w h i c h see i t s e l f as a s e p a20r a t e u n i t a n d , more i m p o r t a n t l y , i s
seen by o u t s i d e r s as a u n i t .
G i v e n t h a t t h i s i s t h e group w h i c h i s g r a n t e d o r n o t g r a n t e d

s t a t u s , on what b a s i s does t h e group a t t a i n i t ? There a r e t h r e e


37

primary sources of status f o r the kindred. They a r e , 1)

p o s i t i o n i n t h e r i t u a l h i e r a r c h y , 2) t r a d i t i o n a l occupation,

and 3) membership i n a p o l i t i c a l faction operating w i t h i n the

village (and sometimes o u t s i d e t h e v i l l a g e as w e l l ) .

Each o f these three sources o f k i n d r e d s t a t u s i s an

analytical aspect o f what i s u s u a l l y d e s c r i b e d as t h e c a s t e

s y s t e m ( s e e t h e a p p e n d i x f o r a g e n e r a l d e f i n i t i o n and d i s -

c u s s i o n o f caste). No m a t t e r t h e r e g i o n and no m a t t e r t h e

particular focus of the observer, every community s t u d y o r

f o r t h a t matter every s t u d y o f s o c i a l a c t i o n must t a k e Into

account the caste system. There a r e c o n s i d e r a b l e v a r i a t i o n s

i n t h e way i n w h i c h c a s t e o p e r a t e s from r e g i o n t o r e g i o n ,

but t h e r e a r e no r e g i o n s i n w h i c h i t does n o t o p e r a t e i n the

Hindu areas o f the subcontinent. Even i n t h e predominantly

Muslim areas there are m a n i f e s t a t i o n s of i t s operation. The

c a s t e s y s t e m i s v e r y o l d and has undergone c o n s i d e r a b l e change

s i n c e i t s i n c e p t i o n a t the time of the D r a v i d i a n submission

to t h e i n v a d i n g Aryans from t h e n o r t h . The f o u r original

religious v a r n a have p r o l i f e r a t e d into s e v e r a l thousand

21

secular 'economic' c a s t e s ( o r p e r h a p s more a p p r o p r i a t e l y ,

j a t i s ) some o f w h i c h have a s m a l l l o c a l membership, some a

r e g i o n a l , and some a l a r g e n a t i o n a l membership. These jatis

are a l l r a n k e d r e l a t i v e t o one a n o t h e r such t h a t members o f

each j a t i a r e aware w h i c h j a t i s r a n k above them and w h i c h b e l o i

The c l o s e r t h e d i s t a n c e between two j a t i s t h e more t h e r e i s

s p e c i f i c knowledge about each o t h e r . The way i n w h i c h one


j a t i member behaves t o w a r d a member o f a n o t h e r j a t i i s related

t o t h e d i s t a n c e , e i t h e r above o r b e l o w , t h a t e x i s t s between

them. There i s no c l e a r c u t a b s o l u t e r a n k i n g f o r i n one r e g i o n

one j a t i may be r e c k o n e d h i g h e r r i t u a l l y r e l a t i v e t o o t h e r jatls

t h a n i t m i g h t be i n a n o t h e r region.
The b a s i s f o r e s t a b l i s h i n g r a n k i n v o l v e s s u c h t h i n g s as who
22
w i l l e a t w i t h whom, who w i l l a c c e p t w h i c h k i n d s o f f o o d from
23
whom, and who w i l l m a r r y whom. As w e l l as t h e s e k i n d s o f

a c t i v i t i e s t h e a p p r o a c h t o r e l i g i o n by each c a s t e must be t a k e n

i n t o account. Brahmins have a p a r t i c u l a r f o r m o f w o r s h i p which

o n l y t h e y c a n employ. L e s s e r c a s t e s may have e l e m e n t s o f t h e

B r a h m i n f o r m o f w o r s h i p , b u t s h o u l d t h e y a t t e m p t t o copy t h e

Brahmins t o o c l o s e l y t h e y r u n t h e r i s k o f a sound b e a t i n g .

Occupation o f t h e c a s t e has a d e c i s i v e e f f e c t on c a s t e

status. The h i g h e s t s t a t u s o c c u p a t i o n s are those which Involve

no p h y s i c a l l a b o u r o r t h o s e w h i c h a r e n o t d i r e c t l y concerned

w i t h p r o d u c t i o n o f goods ( f o r example t h e B r a h m i n p r i e s t s ) .

The n e x t group o f o c c u p a t i o n s are those which i n v o l v e working

the l a n d ( p r o v i d i n g i t i s t h e owner who i s w o r k i n g ) . Equal

or p e r h a p s s l i g h t l y b e l o w t h e c u l t i v a t o r s a r e t h e a r t i s a n s who

m a n u f a c t u r e t h e t o o l s needed f o r p r o d u c t i o n . The l o w e s t ranked

c a s t e s i n terms o f o c c u p a t i o n a r e t h o s e castes which are

responsible f o r p r o v i d i n g services t o the higher castes. These

castes are the m a j o r i t y of the v i l l a g e p o p u l a t i o n . Below t h e

castes are the outcastes. These a r e p e o p l e who do n o t b e l o n g

w i t h i n t h e caste system because t h e i r occupations are too


40

degrading. These p e o p l e c l e a n t h e s t r e e t s , remove dead ani-

mals, e t c . They a r e a l s o known as t h e u n t o u c h a b l e s because

to t o u c h them i s p o l l u t i n g and r e q u i r e s a f a i r l y e x t e n s i v e

ceremony t o become p u r e a g a i n .

In some ways t o t a l k about p o s i t i o n I n t h e r i t u a l h i e r a r c h y

and o c c u p a t i o n (because occupation l a r g e l y determines ritual

p o s i t i o n ) as two s e p a r a t e d e v i c e s f o r d e t e r m i n i n g c a s t e s t a t u s

i s t o make a d i s t i n c t i o n n o t w o r t h m a k i n g , b u t i t I s u s e f u l I f

for o n l y one r e a s o n . C a s t e s do change t h e i r o c c u p a t i o n w i t h o u t

immediately affecting their r i t u a l position. For example,

A h i r s who a r e h e r d e r s o c c u p a t i o n a l l y may stop being herders

and become l a n d l e s s l a b o u r e r s . T h i s o c c u p a t i o n i s n o t as pol-

luting ritually so t h a t t h e y g a i n s t a t u s I n terms o f o c c u p a t i o n

w h i l e a t t h e same t i m e r e t a i n i n g t h e i r v e r y low s t a t u s r i t u a l l y .

24
Over a p e r i o d o f t i m e t h e i r r i t u a l p o s i t i o n may improve, but
I t won't do so i m m e d i a t e l y .

The t h i r d method f o r d e t e r m i n i n g s t a t u s f o r t h e c a s t e group

i s membership w i t h i n a p a r t i c u l a r p o l i t i c a l f a c t i o n . I shall

not d i s c u s s t h i s h e r e b e c a u s e i t i s c o v e r e d i n t h e c h a p t e r on

a l l o c a t i o n o f power and responsibility.

A l t h o u g h i t i s p o s s i b l e f o r a c a s t e t o r a n k h i g h i n terms

of o c c u p a t i o n and low i n terms of r i t u a l p o s i t i o n , t h i s k i n d

of d i s c r e p a n c y does not o c c u r v e r y o f t e n . Normally there i s

a h i g h c o r r e l a t i o n between t h e s e t h r e e means o f establishing

relative status. Thus Brahmins who are at the top of the

r i t u a l h i e r a r c h y n o r m a l l y have o c c u p a t i o n s w h i c h do n o t i n v o l v e
41

p h y s i c a l l a b o u r and a r e members o f one o f t h e p o w e r f u l political

factions i n the v i l l a g e . Sweepers r a n k v e r y l o w r i t u a l l y , must

p e r f o r m t h e most m e n i a l t a s k s , and a r e n o t members o f a p o w e r f u l

political f a c t i o n i f t h e y a r e members o f any f a c t i o n s .

I t i s from h i g h s t a t u s households or k i n d r e d s o f coopera-

t i o n that v i l l a g e leaders are s e l e c t e d . The h o u s e h o l d head o f

the household w i t h t h e h i g h e s t s t a t u s w i l l n o r m a l l y occupy t h e

most p o w e r f u l p o s i t i o n i n t h e v i l l a g e . I f one h o u s e h o l d does

n o t emerge c l e a r l y as t h e most p o w e r f u l , t h e n i t i s p o s s i b l e

t h a t p e r s o n a l i t i e s w i l l be t a k e n i n t o c o n s i d e r a t i o n . Compe-

t e n c e i s a f a c t o r o n l y when a l l o t h e r t h i n g s a r e e q u a l . Thus

an i n d i v i d u a l o f g r e a t a b i l i t y b u t a member o f a low s t a t u s

household has v e r y l i t t l e chance o f making h i m s e l f f e l t i n

village affairs. H i s s p h e r e o f a c t i v i t y w i l l be c o n s t r a i n e d

to w i t h i n h i s own c a s t e group o r h o u s e h o l d . He may be r e c o g -

n i z e d as d o i n g a v e r y good j o b a t t h a t l e v e l by t h e r e s t o f

t h e v i l l a g e , b u t he w i l l n o t be i n v i t e d t o h e l p make d e c i s i o n s

at the v i l l a g e level.
42

FOOTNOTES

x
M a r i o n J . L e v y , The S t r u c t u r e o f S o c i e t y ( P r i n c e t o n ,
1 9 5 2 ) , p. 299-
L e v y , The F a m i l y R e v o l u t i o n - Modern C h i n a (Cambridge,
1 9 4 9 ) , C h a p t e r 1.
As an a s i d e and t o go o u t on a l i m b I w o u l d s u g g e s t t h a t
t h e avenues t o power a r e s o n a r r o w l y d e l i n e a t e d t h a t t h e r e i s
a l m o s t n e v e r a q u e s t i o n o f who w i l l become what i n t h e v i l l a g e
activities. T h i s does n o t h o l d t r u e i n t h e t r a n s i t i o n a l v i l -
lages i n I n d i a today because w i t h wider c o n t a c t s i n t h e o u t s i d e
w o r l d t h e r e a r e o t h e r avenues t h a n t h e t r a d i t i o n a l one open.
The t e a c h e r as a r o l e i s one such example and I w i l l d i s c u s s
the r o l e o f t e a c h e r i n v i l l a g e p o l i t i c a l i n t e r a c t i o n i n the
c h a p t e r on t h e s t r u c t u r e o f p o l i t i c a l a l l o c a t i o n . We as o u t -
s i d e r s c a n 'see' t h a t t h e r e a r e many ways t o a c h i e v e power i n
the v i l l a g e , b u t t o t h e a c t o r s t h e r e may n o t be any a l t e r n a t i v e s

The I n f o r m a t i o n f o r r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n w i t h i n t h e h o u s e -
h o l d I s d e v i s e d m a i n l y f r o m t h e f o l l o w i n g books and a r t i c l e s :

Books:
a) A. S. A t t e k a r , The P o s i t i o n o f Women - H i n d u Civiliza-
t i o n (Banaras, 1956).
b) K. M. K a p a d i a , M a r r i a g e and F a m i l y - India (Oxford,
1 9 5 6 ) , 2nd E d .
c) I r w a t t i K a r v e , K i n s h i p O r g a n i z a t i o n - I n d i a (Poona,
1953) •
d) Oscar Lewis, V i l l a g e L i f e - Northern I n d i a (Urbana,
1958) .
e) P. H. P r a b h u , H i n d u S o c i a l O r g a n i z a t i o n (Bombay, 1 9 5 8 ) .

f) A. D. R o s s , The H i n d u F a m i l y - i t s Urban S e t t i n g
( T o r o n t o , 1961) .
g) S. N. S r i n i v a s , M a r r i a g e and F a m i l y - Mysore (Bombay,
1942). '
h) P. Thomas, H i n d u R e l i g i o n , Customs and Manners (Bombay)
43

Articles:
a) F. G. B a i l e y , "The J o i n t F a m i l y - I n d i a , " The Economic
Weekly, Bombay, F e b r u a r y 2 0 , i 9 6 0 .
Andrew C o l l v e r , "The F a m i l y C y c l e - I n d i a and t h e U n i t e d
b)
S t a t e s , " ASR 2 8 ( 1 ) : 8 6 - 9 6 , F e b r u a r y , 1963.

c) J . D. M. D e r r e t t , "The H i s t o r y o f t h e J u r i d i c a l Frame-
work of t h e H i n d u J o i n t F a m i l y , " C o n t r i b u t i o n s t o
I n d i a n S o c i o l o g y , V I , December, 1962.

d) D. Mandelbaum, "The F a m i l y - I n d i a , " The F a m i l y : Its


F u n c t i o n and D e s t i n y , ed. R. N. Anshen (New Y o r k , 1949).

e) D. Mandelbaum, " F a m i l y , J a t i , V i l l a g e , " S t r u c t u r e and


Change I n I n d i a n S o c i e t y , ed. S i n g e r and Cohn ( C h i c a g o ,
1968) .
f) M. E. O p l e r , " V i l l a g e L i f e - N o r t h I n d i a , " P a t t e r n s
f o r Modern L i v i n g , D i v i s i o n 3 , C u l t u r a l P a t t e r n s ,
The D e l p h i a n S o c i e t y ( C h i c a g o , 1 9 5 0 ) .

g) M. E. O p l e r and R. S i n g h , "Two V i l l a g e s o f E a s t e r n
U t t a r P r a d e s h , I n d i a ; An A n a l y s i s o f D i f f e r e n c e s and
S i m i l a r i t i e s , " AA, V o l . 54, 1952.

h) Henry O r e n s t e i n , "The R e c e n t H i s t o r y o f t h e Extended


F a m i l y - I n d i a , " S o c i a l Problems

i) G i t e l P. S t e e d , "Notes on an A p p r o a c h t o a Study o f
P e r s o n a l i t y Formation - a Hindu V i l l a g e - G u j a r a t , "
V i l l a g e I n d i a , ed. M a r r i o t t ( C h i c a g o , 1955).

S. N. S r i n i v a s , M a r r i a g e and' F a m i l y - Mysore (Bombay,


1 9 4 2 ) , p. 171.
^ D a v i d G. Mandelbaum, " F a m i l y , J a t i , V i l l a g e , " S t r u c t u r e
and Change - I n d i a n S o c i e t y , ed. M i l t o n and S i n g e r ( C h i c a g o ,
1 9 F 8 ) , p. 26.
F o r t h e v i l l a g e as a whole f e m a l e s are q u i t e i m p o r t a n t .
Females who marry i n t o a n o t h e r v i l l a g e p r o v i d e l i n k s between
two v i l l a g e s . There are s t a t i s t i c s w h i c h show t h e e x t e n t t o
w h i c h f e m a l e s marry i n t o p a r t i c u l a r o u t s i d e v i l l a g e s and t h e
k i n d s o f r e l a t i o n s h i p s w h i c h t h e n e x i s t between t h e two v i l l a g e s .
I t i s much more d i f f i c u l t t o m a i n t a i n an argument w i t h a v i l l a g e
i n w h i c h l i v e t h e d a u g h t e r s and d a u g h t e r s - i n - l a w o f t h e p r o -
tagonists .
44

7 In Mayer's Ramkheri s t u d y o n l y two o u t o f 194 m a r r i a g e s


o c c u r r e d between i n d i v i d u a l s who were b o t h r e s i d e n t s o f t h e
village. Of t h e s e m a r r i a g e s , 184 were v i r i l o c a l . Marriott,
i n h i s s t u d y on K i s h a n G a r h i , p o i n t s o u t t h a t o n l y once I n
t h r e e g e n e r a t i o n s has a m a r r i a g e o c c u r r e d between K i s h a n
G a r h i and any o f e l e v e n o t h e r s u r r o u n d i n g v i l l a g e s . The
a v e r a g e d i s t a n c e between n a t a l home and c o n j u g a l home f o r
the women i s 12 m i l e s , a f a i r l y g r e a t d i s t a n c e i n v i l l a g e I n d i a .

C o l l v e r , op_. c i t .
Q
L e w i s , op_. c i t .
10
M a n d e l b a u m , " F a m i l y , J a t i , V i l l a g e , " p. 3 2 .
11
There a r e two r e a s o n s f o r s u g g e s t i n g t h i s . First,i f
t h e w i f e does n o t p r o v e t o be what e i t h e r t h e h u s b a n d , o r ,
more p a r t i c u l a r l y , t h e husband's p a r e n t s t h i n k she s h o u l d be
she can be s e n t b a c k t o h e r p a r e n t s . T h i s i s a f a i r l y d r a s t i c
move, b u t i t i s employed I f t h e w i f e p r o v e s t o be t o o r e c a l c i -
trant. The s e c o n d r e a s o n i s t h a t e v e r y woman d e s i r e s m a r r i a g e
because she i s n o t r e a l l y welcome p a s t p u b e r t y I n h e r n a t a l
home. Once she i s m a r r i e d t h e n a t a l f a m i l y w o u l d l o o k w i t h
extreme d i s f a v o u r upon h e r permanent r e t u r n . S t r i c t l y s p e a k i n g
one c o u l d s a y t h a t t h e woman has a c h o i c e between s t a y i n g w i t h
her c o n j u g a l f a m i l y or r e t u r n i n g t o the n a t a l f a m i l y , b u t i n
r e a l i t y she has no c h o i c e . G i v e n t h e above t h e f e m a l e w o u l d
r a t h e r r e m a i n i n t h e c o n j u g a l h o u s e h o l d and I t h i n k one c a n
assume t h a t she w i l l do h e r b e s t t o g e t a l o n g w i t h a l l o f t h e
members o f t h e c o n j u g a l h o u s e h o l d . T h i s may i n v o l v e e f f o r t s
on h e r p a r t t o m o d i f y e i t h e r h e r own b e h a v i o u r o r t h a t o f t h e
o t h e r members. S i n c e she I s a d e f i n i t e m i n o r i t y most o f t h e
changes w i l l p r o b a b l y o c c u r w i t h i n h e r own b e h a v i o u r . As a
consequence o f t h i s I w o u l d s u g g e s t t h a t q u i t e s t r o n g bonds
a r e formed between t h e husband and w i f e . They may n o t n e c e s -
s a r i l y be b a s e d on a f f e c t i o n , b u t t h e y n o n e t h e l e s s do e x i s t .
The r e l a t i o n s h i p w h i c h e x i s t s between Wang Lung and h i s w i f e
in" P e a r l Buck's The Good E a r t h i s a good example. Each i s a
s t r a n g e r t o t h e o t h e r a t t i m e o f m a r r i a g e and each has c e r t a i n
r e a s o n s f o r e n t e r i n g i n t o t h e s t a t e o f m a r r i a g e , and so l o n g as
the o t h e r p a r t n e r f u l f i l l s e x p e c t a t i o n s t h e r e l a t i o n s h i p i s
smooth. A f f e c t i o n I s n o t e x p e c t e d t o be p a r t o f t h e r e l a t i o n -
s h i p b u t i t c e r t a i n l y does d e v e l o p . I t h i n k i t w o u l d be v e r y
d i f f i c u l t t o compare m a r r i a g e and d i v o r c e s t a t i s t i c s I n I n d i a
w i t h those o f t h e U n i t e d S t a t e s because t h e approach t o these
r o l e s I s so d i f f e r e n t . I n I n d i a , s t r a n g e r s marry and hope t o
d e v e l o p a f f e c t i o n and i n t h e U n i t e d S t a t e s I n d i v i d u a l s who have
a f f e c t i o n f o r one a n o t h e r marry and hope t o d e v e l o p o t h e r bonds
t o s t r e n g t h e n t h e bonds.
45

12
Mandelbaum, " F a m i l y , J a t i , V i l l a g e , " p. 33-
13
I assume t h e i n f o r m a t i o n i s n o t a v a i l a b l e s i m p l y b e c a u s e
t h o s e who have s t u d i e d t h e I n d i a n v i l l a g e have n o t a s k e d t h e
a p p r o p r i a t e q u e s t i o n s . The r e s e a r c h e r s were c o n c e r n e d about
other things.
14
A f r i c a n Systems o f K i n s h i p and M a r r i a g e , e d . R a d c l i f f e -
Brown and D a r y l l Forde~T"London, 1 9 5 0 ) , S e c t i o n U o f t h e
Introduction.
15
Mandelbaum, " F a m i l y , J a t i , V i l l a g e , " p p . 3 0 - 3 7 -
l 6
I b i d . , p. 37-
17
A d r i a n C. M a y e r , C a s t e and K i n s h i p - C e n t r a l I n d i a
(London, I 9 6 0 ) , p a r t i c u l a r l y t h e I n t r o d u c t i o n .
l8
The s i z e o f t h e k i n d r e d may v a r y a c c o r d i n g t o t h e i s s u e
at hand. I s s u e s may a r i s e w h i c h l e a d t o t h e s p l i t t i n g o f t h e
k i n d r e d , e i t h e r t e m p o r a r i l y o r p e r m a n e n t l y . C o n v e r s e l y , new
k i n d r e d s may be formed as t h e r e s u l t o f o t h e r i s s u e s .
19
T h e o r e t i c a l l y a l l members o f a c a s t e c a n t r a c e t h e i r
i n d i v i d u a l b i o l o g i c a l l i n e s b a c k t o a common p o i n t so t h a t
a l l c a s t e members a r e r e l a t e d .
20
For a f u r t h e r d i s c u s s i o n of the kindred o f cooperation
w i t h i n t h e c o n t e x t o f c a s t e see t h e a p p e n d i x on C a s t e .
21
Secular r e l a t i v e t o the o r i g i n a l idea of varna but
d e f i n i t e l y n o t s e c u l a r as we t h i n k o f s e c u l a r I n o u r s o c i e t y .
22
The h i g h e r r a n k e d c a s t e w i l l a c c e p t uncooked b u t n o t
cooked f o o d f r o m t h e l o w e r r a n k e d c a s t e . The l o w e r r a n k e d
w i l l a c c e p t b o t h cooked and uncooked f r o m t h e h i g h e r r a n k e d
caste.
23
M a l e s may marry down, f e m a l e s must marry I n t o t h e same
c a s t e o r h i g h e r . The d i s t a n c e between c a s t e s cannot be t o o
g r e a t , however. F o r example, s h o u l d a Brahmin male marry an
o u t c a s t e f e m a l e he becomes o u t c a s t e as w e l l .
24
1) F. G. B a i l e y , T r i b e , C a s t e and N a t i o n (Manchester,
I 9 6 0 ) , pp. 211-27-
2) R a l p h W. N i c h o l a s , " P o l i t i c s I n V i l l a g e s o f S o u t h e r n
A s i a , " S t r u c t u r e and Change - I n d i a n S o c i e t y ( C h i c a g o , 1 9 6 8 ) ,
pp. 2 7 3 ^
CHAPTER I I I 1

Structure of S o l i d a r i t y

I n t h e p r e v i o u s c h a p t e r I have d i s c u s s e d t h e way i n w h i c h

r o l e s a r e a l l o c a t e d among t h e v a r i o u s v i l l a g e r s . Implied i n

the d e f i n i t i o n of r o l e Is a separation o f v i e w p o i n t s because

the o c c u p a n t o f each r o l e l o o k s upon each s i t u a t i o n f r o m a

d i f f e r e n t vantage p o i n t . I n t h i s chapter I propose t o analyze

that structure which operates t o standardize the r e l a t i o n s h i p s

between t h e s e r o l e s . I am n o t c o n c e r n e d w i t h the structures

w h i c h o p e r a t e i n any s o c i e t y to integrate r o l e s ; rather I am

concerned w i t h the s t r u c t u r e which functions t o standardize the

modes o f b e h a v i o u r w h i c h a r e c o n s i d e r e d a p p r o p r i a t e between

occupants o f d i f f e r e n t i a t e d r o l e s .

There a r e t h r e e a s p e c t s t o t h e s t r u c t u r e of s o l i d a r i t y

w h i c h must be c o n s i d e r e d i n a n a l y z i n g any r e l a t i o n s h i p between

roles. I s h a l l use L e v y ' s d e f i n i t i o n s f o r each o f t h e t h r e e

following aspects: content, strength,and i n t e n s i t y . The c o n -

tent o f any r e l a t i o n s h i p i s d e f i n e d as ". . . t h e t y p e o f

r e l a t i o n s h i p t h a t i s t o e x i s t and t h e members between ( o r among)


2
whom i t i s t o e x i s t . " The s t r e n g t h of the r e l a t i o n s h i p i s

defined as ". . . t h e r e l a t i v e p r e c e d e n c e o r l a c k o f p r e c e -

dence t a k e n by t h i s r e l a t i o n s h i p o v e r o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p s o f

i t s g e n e r a l s o r t , and o v e r o t h e r o b l i g a t i o n s and commitments

i n the larger s o c i a l sphere." J


The I n t e n s i t y o f t h e r e l a t i o n -

ship i s defined as ". . . t h e s t a t e o f a f f e c t i n v o l v e d i n the

46
47

relationship." There are two possible types of v a r i a t i o n i n

the state of a f f e c t : first, the t y p e of a f f e c t i n v o l v e d (e.g.,

l o v e , h a t e , anger, j o y , r e s p e c t , e t c . ) ; and second, the degree

of a f f e c t i v e i n v o l v e m e n t t h a t i s expected (e.g., whether the

r e l a t i o n s h i p i s t o be intimate o r one of avoidance).

I f I am g r a n t e d the above by way of e x p l a i n i n g and defin-

i n g the structure of s o l i d a r i t y then i t f o l l o w s that the struc-

ture o f s o l i d a r i t y i s c r u c i a l i n a t l e a s t two circumstances:

f i r s t , where the frequency of i n t e r a c t i o n i s high; and second,

where r e l a t i o n s h i p s a r e s t r a t e g i c t o the system (strategic

r e l a t i o n s h i p s may have a h i g h i n c i d e n c e o f i n t e r a c t i o n , but

t h i s need not be the case).

It i s neither possible nor i s i t desirable f o r my purposes

t o t r e a t a l l o f the r e l a t i o n s h i p s w h i c h can o c c u r between

r o l e s w i t h i n the village. Theoretically I should f i n d i t

n e c e s s a r y t o a n a l y z e o n l y the r e l a t i o n s h i p s w h i c h e x i s t between

r o l e s i n the v i l l a g e s o c i a l system, but, as i n the previous

c h a p t e r on r o l e d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n , the s o l i d a r i t y structure of

the lower l e v e l s o c i a l u n i t s (the h o u s e h o l d ) must be considered

as w e l l b e c a u s e t h e y so c o l o u r the upper l e v e l r e l a t i o n s h i p s

t h a t the upper l e v e l r e l a t i o n s h i p s c a n n o t be fully understood

w i t h o u t knowledge of l o w e r l e v e l r e l a t i o n s h i p s . Thus we must

b e g i n by discussing the structure of s o l i d a r i t y as i t functions

a t the l e v e l of the household.

In t h i s chapter, as i n the l a s t , I have had trouble

f i n d i n g any material which deals w i t h the r e l a t i o n s h i p as i t


48

a c t u a l l y operates rather t h a n how i t s h o u l d o p e r a t e i d e a l l y .

Hence much o f t h e m a t e r i a l that i s presented i n t h i s chapter

is suppositional and hypothetical.

SOLIDARITY STRUCTURE WITHIN THE HOUSEHOLD

Of t h e many p o s s i b l e relationships w h i c h e x i s t between

members o f t h e h o u s e h o l d t h e r e a r e two w h i c h must be u n d e r -

s t o o d i n o r d e r t o comprehend t h e s t r u c t u r e of s o l i d a r i t y at

the village level. These a r e t h e f a t h e r - s o n r e l a t i o n s h i p and

the b r o t h e r - b r o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p . At the v i l l a g e l e v e l females

do n o t f i g u r e as p o s s i b i l i t i e s f o r t h e r o l e s w h i c h a r e t o be

allocated. A t t h e h o u s e h o l d l e v e l , f e m a l e s do e f f e c t t h e c o n -

tent, strength, and i n t e n s i t y o f t h e above m e n t i o n e d male

r e l a t i o n s h i p s , but i d e a l l y a t l e a s t they should not e f f e c t

the content, s t r e n g t h or i n t e n s i t y of the v i l l a g e l e v e l

relationships.

1. The F a t h e r - S o n Relationship
B e f o r e c o n t i n u i n g I must m e n t i o n a n o t h e r m a j o r p r o b l e m

w h i c h I have been u n a b l e t o s o l v e (and one w h i c h no one e l s e

has s o l v e d t o my k n o w l e d g e ) . Social relationships a r e dynamic

and my a n a l y s i s i s static. I d e a l l y the r o l e of both father

and son does n o t change w i t h t i m e , n o r does t h e s o l i d a r i t y

structure which orders the r e l a t i o n s h i p . Actually the con-

tent of the r e l a t i o n s h i p changes d r a s t i c a l l y o v e r t i m e as does

the s t r e n g t h and I n t e n s i t y . The f a t h e r - s o n r e l a t i o n s h i p I s

not t h e s.ame when t h e f a t h e r i s t w e n t y - f i v e and t h e s o n f i v e


49

as i t i s when the f a t h e r i s s i x t y and t h e son forty. The best

t h a t I can do i n t h e s e c i r c u m s t a n c e s i s t o examine t h e father-

son r e l a t i o n s h i p a t d i f f e r e n t s t a g e s i n i t s d e v e l o p m e n t .

I n a s o c i a l s y s t e m w h i c h i s c h a r a c t e r i z e d as p a t r i a r c h a l ,

p a t r i l o c a l , and p a t r i l i n e a l I t h i n k i t can s a f e l y be assumed

t h a t t h e t y p e o f r e l a t i o n s h i p w i l l be that of superordinate-

subordinate. The f a t h e r has complete c o n t r o l over the actions

o f t h e son. However, t h e s i t u a t i o n I s n e v e r c l e a r c u t b e c a u s e

t h e young f a t h e r i s as d o m i n a t e d by h i s f a t h e r as he i s dominant

o v e r h i s young son ( i d e a l l y he i s d o m i n a t e d w h e t h e r the father

is s t i l l a l i v e or n o t ) . The f o l l o w i n g , rather lengthy quote,

f r o m G. Morris C a r s t a i r s ' book, The Twice B o r n d e s c r i b e s the

k i n d o f r e l a t i o n s h i p w h i c h e x i s t s between f a t h e r and son among

the upper castes i n t h e v i l l a g e he was observing:

In s t r i k i n g contrast to a l l t h i s a t t e n t i v e mothering,
the c h i l d ' s f a t h e r i s an a l o o f s e e m i n g l y unwelcome
figure. The r e a s o n f o r t h i s i s t h a t a man, so l o n g
as he r e m a i n s u n d e r h i s own f a t h e r ' s r o o f , must keep
up the f i c t i o n o f d e n y i n g t h a t he l e a d s an a c t i v e s e x u a l
l i f e o f h i s own. Not t o do so i s t o be d i s r e s p e c t f u l .
C o n s e q u e n t l y , a man and h i s w i f e can n e v e r t a l k t o each
other n a t u r a l l y , i n h i s parents' presence; nor i s i t
p r o p e r t o e i t h e r o f them t o show a f f e c t i o n f o r t h e i r
own c h i l d r e n i n f r o n t o f t h e i r e l d e r s . T h i s o b l i g a t o r y
s u p p r e s s i o n o f any o v e r t show of t e n d e r f e e l i n g s I s
r e l a x e d o n l y when t h e c h i l d c r i e s . Then h i s needs
t a k e p r e c e d e n c e even o v e r the g r a n d p a r e n t s ' a u t h o r i t y ,
so t h a t he w i l l be handed o v e r t o h i s m o t h e r , o f t e n
w i t h the command " G i v e him the b r e a s t . " A father,
however, e x p e r i e n c e s no such e x c e p t i o n t o the demand
t h a t he r e m a i n i m p a s s i v e and d e t a c h e d . Even i f h i s
w i f e o r c h i l d f a l l s i l l he must c o n t a i n h i s f e e l i n g s
and s u r r e n d e r t h e r e s p o n s i b i l i t y of tendingthe.m t o h i s
own p a r e n t s . T h i s taboo p e r p e t u a t e s I n each g e n e r a t i o n
t h e t e n s i o n w h i c h e x i s t s between f a t h e r and son; and i t
i s very strong. Young Chauthmal", who l i v e d i n h i s
f a t h e r Bhurmal's h o u s e , had a boy of e i g h t e e n months,
50

and o f t e n t h e g r a n d f a t h e r c o u l d be s e e n c a r r y i n g t h i s
c h i l d i n h i s arms, o r d a n d l i n g h i m w h i l e t h e y s a t a t
t h e i r s h o p — b u t never Chauthmal: " I don't l i k e t o
f o n d l e h i m , even when we a r e a l o n e i n o u r room," he
said: " i f I d i d , he m i g h t g e t i n t o t h e h a b i t o f
r u n n i n g t o my knee i n t h e b a z a a r , and t h a t w o u l d n o t
look r i g h t . " . . . On t h e o t h e r hand, t h e r e were
t h r e e among my y o u n g e r I n f o r m a n t s who d i s r e g a r d e d t h e
r u l e , and o p e n l y f o n d l e d t h e i r young c h i l d r e n . They
were a b l e t o do s o b e c a u s e i n each case t h e i r f a t h e r s
were d e a d , and t h e y were t h e heads o f t h e i r s e v e r a l
households: b u t s t i l l t h e c o n s e n s u s o f o p i n i o n (as
t h e y were w e l l aware) condemned t h e i r unashamed d i s p l a y
of a f f e c t i o n . . . . The u s u a l f a t h e r - c h i l d r e l a t i o n s h i p ,
t h e n , was d r a i n e d o f s p o n t a n e o u s warmth o f f e e l i n g .
I n s t e a d i t was g o v e r n e d by s t r i c t o b l i g a t i o n s on e i t h e r
side. . . .The o b l i g a t i o n o f each t o t h e o t h e r , o f
f i n a n c i a l s u p p o r t and i n s t r u c t i o n on t h e one h a n d , and
d u t i f u l s e r v i c e t h r o u g h o u t one's f a t h e r ' s l i f e (and
a f t e r h i s d e a t h ) on t h e o t h e r , were c o n s t a n t l y empha- ,-
s i z e d , b u t p e r s o n a l i n t i m a c y was c o n s p i c u o u s l y a b s e n t .

The above o b s e r v a t i o n s , made on t h e c o n t e n t , s t r e n g t h ,

and i n t e n s i t y o f t h e f a t h e r - s o n r e l a t i o n s h i p among t h e t h r e e

h i g h e s t c a s t e s i n t h e v i l l a g e o f D e o l i , a r e made on a s i t u a -

t i o n where, i n f a c t , t h e r e i s more o p p o r t u n i t y t o l i v e up t o

the i d e a l f a t h e r - s o n r e l a t i o n s h i p . Among the - l o w e r c a s t e s one

would not expect these o b s e r v a t i o n s t o be made f o r a t l e a s t

two reasons. As C a r s t a i r s o b s e r v e d , i t i s the presence of

the g r a n d f a t h e r and/or grandmother w h i c h c o n s t r a i n s t h e

behaviour o f the f a t h e r w i t h r e s p e c t t o the son i n the upper

castes. Among t h e l o w e r castes the presence of grandfathers

and grandmothers w i t h i n t h e f a m i l y i s even more u n l i k e l y than

among t h e u p p e r c a s t e s where t h e p r o b a b i l i t y i s o n l y about

fifty-fifty t h a t b o t h p a r e n t s w i l l be s u r v i v i n g a t t h e t i m e

o f t h e son's m a r r i a g e . There i s a f a i r l y good c o r r e l a t i o n

between c a s t e r a n k i n g and w e a l t h (the h i g h e r the caste the


51

more l i k e l y t h a t c a s t e w i l l be w e a l t h y ) and t h e r e i s a f a i r l y

h i g h c o r r e l a t i o n between w e a l t h and l i f e expectancy.

The second r e a s o n i s t h a t among t h e l o w e r c a s t e s t h e r e i s

very l i t t l e o p p o r t u n i t y f o r a f a t h e r t o accumulate wealth over

w h i c h he has c o n t r o l i n h i s o l d age. I n a wealthy household

t h e aged f a t h e r has no r e a l need o f p h y s i c a l s t r e n g t h , he

m e r e l y needs t h e m e n t a l a b i l i t y t o make d e c i s i o n s c o n c e r n i n g

its disposition. The f a t h e r c a n be t r a d i t i o n a l l y oriented

because he has t h e power t o b a c k h i s p o s i t i o n . Among t h e p o o r

l o w e r c a s t e s when a man l o s e s h i s p h y s i c a l p o w e r s , as he

i n e v i t a b l y must, he c a n hope t h a t h i s s o n w i l l f o l l o w tradi-

t i o n and p r o v i d e f o r h i m i n h i s o l d age. Thus when t h e s o n

i s t h e main c o n t r i b u t o r o r o n l y s o u r c e o f h o u s e h o l d income

he need n o t pay a t t e n t i o n t o t h e demands o f h i s f a t h e r . It

i s much e a s i e r i n t h e p o o r e r h o u s e h o l d s f o r the son t o take

o v e r f r o m h i s f a t h e r and b e g i n t o make d e c i s i o n s about t h e

d i s p o s i t i o n o f t h e h o u s e h o l d Income. Concomitantly the poorer

h o u s e h o l d heads may e x h i b i t d i f f e r e n t b e h a v i o u r p a t t e r n s towards

t h e i r sons t h a n I s f o u n d among t h e w e a l t h y , h i g h - c a s t e h o u s e -

holds. F a t h e r s and sons w i l l p r o b a b l y spend more t i m e , more

p l e a s a n t l y and l e s s f o r m a l l y , w i t h one a n o t h e r .

A t h i r d f a c t o r w h i c h i s p r o b a b l y n o t as i m p o r t a n t as t h e

f i r s t two i s t h a t w h i l e t h e r e I s a l o t o f d i r e c t c o n t a c t between

f a t h e r and s o n among poor h o u s e h o l d s t h i s does n o t h o l d among

wealthy households. The f a t h e r i n t h e w e a l t h y h o u s e h o l d appears,


52

and more l i k e l y i s , as a more d i s t a n t f i g u r e t o t h e s o n . He

does n o t have many d i r e c t d e a l i n g s w i t h h i m . Mother, grand-

p a r e n t s , t e a c h e r and p o s s i b l y s e r v a n t s w i l l s t a n d between h i m

and h i s father.

Even among w e a l t h y h o u s e h o l d s , however, i t i s p o s s i b l e

f o r the father t o f l y i n the face of t r a d i t i o n with respect

t o h i s b e h a v i o u r towards h i s son. While i t i s i m p o r t a n t t o

know t h a t extreme v a r i a t i o n s c a n and do e x i s t w i t h regard to

the content, strength, and i n t e n s i t y o f t h e f a t h e r - s o n rela-

tionship I think that t h e more n o r m a l t y p e o f s o l i d a r i t y struc-

ture that e x i s t s between some r o l e s on t h e v i l l a g e l e v e l more

nearly resembles that of the wealthy household than that of

the p o o r e r h o u s e h o l d s . The i n t e r v e n t i o n of caste i n t o the

structure of s o l i d a r i t y at the v i l l a g e l e v e l resembles the

intervention o f t h e m o t h e r , g r a n d p a r e n t s , t e a c h e r and s e r v a n t s

at t h e h o u s e h o l d level.

I s h a l l discuss s h o r t l y which r o l e s i n the v i l l a g e seem

t o have a s o l i d a r i t y s t r u c t u r e modeled a f t e r t h e s o l i d a r i t y

structure o f t h e f a t h e r - s o n r e l a t i o n s h i p , b u t b e f o r e I do so

I wish t o discuss the s o l i d a r i t y structure of the brother-

b r o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p on w h i c h o t h e r v i l l a g e r o l e s a r e b a s e d .

2. The B r o t h e r - B r o t h e r Relationship

One cannot say t h a t the b r o t h e r - b r o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p i s

a s t r o n g one e x c e p t i n c e r t a i n c i r c u m s t a n c e s . There a r e a

number o f o t h e r h o u s e h o l d r e l a t i o n s h i p s w h i c h c a n and do
53

assume p r e c e d e n c e over the brother-brother relationship. Some

examples a r e t h e f a t h e r - s o n , mother-son and husband-wife

relationships. The d i f f e r e n t i a t i o n of brothers occurs on t h e

basis of relative age. The e l d e s t son I s expected t o take

over t h e h o u s e h o l d and r i t u a l obligations of the father after

the father's death. Neither the eldest brother nor the

younger b r o t h e r ( s ) h a v e much p o w e r t o make d e c i s i o n s while

the father i s alive (and capable o f making d e c i s i o n s ) so t h a t

the d i f f e r e n c e i n r o l e s i s n o t much e m p h a s i z e d . As t h e b r o -

thers g r o w up t h e y r e c e i v e much t h e same s o r t o f t r e a t m e n t

from others i n the household. The y o u n g e r b r o t h e r may i n f a c t

r e c e i v e more a t t e n t i o n s i m p l y because i ti s the older brother

who w i l l h a v e t h e a d v a n t a g e w h e n t h e f a t h e r dies.

I n a d d i t i o n t o t h e above b r o t h e r s inherit equally from

the estate of the father—although the senior s o n may b e

granted something e x t r a from the estate t o compensate f o r

the e x t r a r i t u a l expenses b e i n g head o f t h e f a m i l y .

Although i n theory the elder brother should stand i nthe

same k i n d o f r e l a t i o n s h i p t o h i s y o u n g e r b r o t h e r as t h e f a t h e r

stands t o h i s s o n , t h i s kind o f r e l a t i o n s h i p c a n n o t be m a i n -

tained—particularly a f t e r the f a t h e r i s dead. The f a t h e r c a n

c o n t r o l h i s son because whatever w e a l t h t h e household has i s

i n h i s n a m e , b u t e a c h b r o t h e r h a s h i s own s o u r c e of wealth i f

any. To q u o t e a g a i n f r o m C a r s t a i r s ,

I n p r i n c i p l e , t h e same s u b s e r v i e n c e was p o s t u l a t e d i n
r e l a t i o n t o one's e l d e r brother." As R a j m a l p u t i t :
54

" i f my f a t h e r o r my e l d e r b r o t h e r t e l l s me t o s t a n d
i n one p l a c e , I ' l l s t a n d t h e r e , d a m m i t , a l l day i f
n e e d b e , u n t i l t h e y t e l l me I c a n move." He was
e x a g g e r a t i n g , b e c a u s e he w a s , i n f a c t , a man o f v e r y
i n d e p e n d e n t s p i r i t ; a n d l i k e some o t h e r y o u n g e r s o n s
i n t h e v i l l a g e , he w e n t h i s own w a y , s e l d o m b o t h e r i n g
to consult h i s elder brother. In general, however,
e l d e r b r o t h e r s were a c c o r d e d , at l e a s t i n p u b l i c ,
t h e d e f e r e n c e due t o t h e i r p o s i t i o n i n t h e f a m i l y ; a n d
t h e same r e s t r a i n t was o b s e r v e d b y a y o u n g e r b r o t h e r
i n s u p p r e s s i n g a l l show o f a f f e c t i o n t o w a r d s h i s w i f e
a n d c h i l d r e n b e f o r e a n e l d e r b r o t h e r , as b e f o r e h i s
father. As H i r a S i n g h p u t i t : " E v e n I f s h e i s s i c k ,
I w o u l d n o t l i k e t o s a y t h i s t o my e l d e r b r o t h e r —
but i f younger b r o t h e r i s t h e r e , I can t e l l him and
a s k h i m t o go f o r m e d i c i n e . " Hari L a i extended t h i s
category further saying: " E v e r y man h a s g o t f i v e
f a t h e r s , and i t i s h i s d u t y t o obey them w i t h o u t q u e s -
t i o n , w h a t e v e r they ask him t o do. They a r e , h i s
f a t h e r , h i s e l d e r b r o t h e r , h i s k i n g , h i s g u r u , and
his friends."6

I t w o u l d seem f r o m t h e above t h a t t h e distinction

between b r o t h e r s i s p e r h a p s most i m p o r t a n t after childhood.

As we s h a l l see in a later chapter, i t i s important that

brothers stick t o g e t h e r i n e c o n o m i c and political matters

b e c a u s e t h e y h a v e m o r e p o w e r as a g r o u p t h a n as I n d i v i d u a l s .

This combined w i t h the power of t r a d i t i o n a l r e s p e c t for the

elder brother means t h a t i t w i l l be the elder brother who

makes d e c i s i o n s after taking into c o n s i d e r a t i o n the attitudes

and desires of h i s younger b r o t h e r . Often the brothers will

maintain joint property e v e n t h o u g h t h e y h a v e s e t up separate

households. The ideal is a joint h o u s e h o l d , ( c f . p. ), but

this is difficult to maintain because the wives so often quar-

r e l with one a n o t h e r a b o u t who i s t o make w h a t k i n d s of deci-

s i o n s w i t h i n the household. (This is particularly true after

the death of the mother-in-law.)


55

Sometimes b r o t h e r s do q u a r r e l and d e c i d e t o go s e p a r a t e

ways. This i s u s u a l l y at the i n s t i g a t i o n of t h e i r respective

wives. What happens i n e f f e c t i s t h a t t h e w i v e s have forced

t h e i r husbands t o g i v e p r e c e d e n c e t o t h e h u s b a n d - w i f e relation-

ship over the b r o t h e r - b r o t h e r relationship. When t h e b r o t h e r -

brother r e l a t i o n s h i p i s f o r c e d t o give precedence t o other

r e l a t i o n s h i p s i t may b r e a k down c o m p l e t e l y . Brothers actually

j o i n p o l i t i c a l f a c t i o n s w h i c h a r e opposed q u i t e b i t t e r l y t o

one another. They may even be t h e heads o f t h e s e f a c t i o n s .

( A c t u a l l y i t i s p o s s i b l e t h a t f a c t i o n s may be formed i n t h i s

way as we s h a l l see l a t e r . )

SOLIDARITY STRUCTURES AT THE VILLAGE LEVEL

D u r i n g t h e r e s t o f t h i s c h a p t e r I s h a l l be d i s c u s s i n g t h e

s o l i d a r i t y s t r u c t u r e s which e x i s t f o r r e l a t i o n s h i p s a t the

village level. J u s t as t h e i n d i v i d u a l i s t h e b a s i c u n i t o f

t h e h o u s e h o l d so on t h e v i l l a g e l e v e l t h e h o u s e h o l d i s t h e

basic unit. The e l d e s t male i s t h e head o f t h e h o u s e h o l d and

I n any r e l a t i o n s h i p s o u t s i d e of the household at the v i l l a g e

l e v e l t h e head o f h o u s e h o l d r e p r e s e n t s the household. House-

h o l d s a r e i n t e r a c t i n g and t h e p o i n t s of i n t e r a c t i o n ( i n t e r -

s e c t i o n ) a r e t h e r e s p e c t i v e household heads. There a r e e s s e n -

t i a l l y two t y p e s o f r e l a t i o n s h i p s i n t o w h i c h h o u s e h o l d s enter

at the v i l l a g e l e v e l : f i r s t , those i n which caste i s Involved

and s e c o n d , t h o s e w h i c h have t o do w i t h t h e j a j m a n i system

(.cf. p. ).
56

S O L I D A R I T Y STRUCTURES I N THE CASTE SYSTEM

Solidarity structures order the r e l a t i o n s h i p s which

exist i n b o t h i n t r a c a s t e and I n t e r c a s t e situations. I shall

discuss first the intracaste situation and second t h e i n t e r -

caste situation.

1. Solidarity Structures as They O r d e r I n t r a c a s t e Relationships

I would hypothesize that r e l a t i o n s h i p s o f an i n t r a c a s t e

nature a r e o r d e r e d i n much t h e same f a s h i o n as t h e b r o t h e r -

brother relationships i s ordered. The b e h a v i o u r w h i c h i s

m a n i f e s t e d by t h e i n t e r a c t i o n of brothers i s very similar

t o t h a t m a n i f e s t e d when t h e h o u s e h o l d h e a d s who make up t h e


7
caste panchayat interact. Membership i n t h e caste panchayat

is ascribed t o t h e same d e g r e e t h a t t h e male s i b l i n g group I s

ascribed within the household. R e l a t i v e age i s i m p o r t a n t i n

determining who w i l l b e t h e h e a d o f t h e c a s t e panchayat.

However, i n s t e a d o f r e l a t i v e age as t h e p r i m e selective

f a c t o r f o r panchayat l e a d e r s h i p , I t i s the s i z e and w e a l t h

of the household which the i n d i v i d u a l r e p r e s e n t s . That

i n d i v i d u a l who h a s t h e l a r g e s t a n d w e a l t h i e s t h o u s e h o l d behind

him w i l l be t h e r a n k i n g member o f t h e c a s t e panchayat unless

of c o u r s e h e i s much y o u n g e r t h a n any o f t h e o t h e r panchayat

members. As t h e h e a d o f t h e h o u s e h o l d i s r e s p o n s i b l e f o r

the b e h a v i o u r o f a l l t h e members o f t h e h o u s e h o l d , s o t h e

head o f t h e c a s t e p a n c h a y a t w i l l be h e l d responsible f o r the

b e h a v i o u r o f t h e members o f t h e c a s t e _ r e s i d e n t w i t h i n t h e

village. This responsibility i s more t h e o r e t i c a l t h a n real,


57

although i t does have r e a l i s t i c elements, because, just as the

eldest male of the sibling group does not have absolute

authority over h i s s i b l i n g s and must s e c u r e t h e i r consent

in some s o r t o f h o u s e h o l d c o u n c i l , so that ranking panchayat

member m u s t s e c u r e t h e consent of h i s f e l l o w members. More

simply stated the r a n k i n g member o f the caste panchayat and

the eldest male of the sibling group are each i n t h e i r set-

ting the first among e q u a l s . Like the sibling group there

are t i m e s when o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p s take precedence over this

p a r t i c u l a r one. Intercaste relationships seem t o take prece-

dence o v e r i n t r a c a s t e relationships j u s t as the father-son

relationship takes precedence over the brother-brother

relationship.

There i s a g r e a t e r frequency of i n t e r a c t i o n at the intra-

caste l e v e l and l e s s power d i f f e r e n t i a l between the heads of

households i n the same c a s t e and h e n c e t h e r e w o u l d seem to

be a greater p o s s i b i l i t y f o r a f f e c t i o n t o be manifested and

f o r the relationships t o be more i n t i m a t e . The development

of intimate and affectionate relationships depends, I think,

upon the s i z e of the caste. I f there are only f o u r or five

households living within the village i t i s much e a s i e r for

h o u s e h o l d h e a d s t o b e h a v e as s i b l i n g s t o w a r d one another. Just

as one can I m a g i n e i t t o be a difficult thing for a large sib-

ling group to act In concert i n a l l matters so i t is difficult

f o r a c a s t e panchayat of twenty or thirty members t o maintain

a g r e e m e n t on a l l matters a f f e c t i n g them. N o r m a l l y , what happens,


58

as I s h a l l discuss i n the c h a p t e r on p o l i t i c a l structure,

i s that factions appear. There w i l l be several groups of

h o u s e h o l d heads w i t h i n the p a n c h a y a t - - e a c h group a c t i n g as

a unit with a head who Interacts with the heads of the other

groups.

2. S o l i d a r i t y Structures In I n t e r c a s t e Relationships

I f the b e h a v i o u r p a t t e r n s m a n i f e s t e d i n intracaste

r e l a t i o n s h i p s b e a r c l o s e r e s e m b l a n c e t o t h o s e of the brother-

b r o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p , then i n t e r c a s t e r e l a t i o n s h i p s bear a

s i m i l a r r e s e m b l a n c e t o the father-son relationship. Just as

the father g i v e s o r d e r s and i n s t r u c t i o n s t o the son and

e x p e c t s them t o be c a r r i e d out so a h i g h e r c a s t e gives

o r d e r s and i n s t r u c t i o n s t o a l o w e r c a s t e and e x p e c t s them

t o be obeyed. As the son i s responsible t o the father and

the father i s responsible f o r the son so w i t h the upper caste

and lower caste. As the son depends upon h i s f a t h e r f o r sup-

p o r t but not vice versa, so the l o w e r c a s t e s depend upon the

upper c a s t e s but not vice versa. As the father-son relation-

s h i p t a k e s p r e c e d e n c e o v e r any o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p f o r the son

but not vice versa, so the upper c a s t e - l o w e r c a s t e relationship

t a k e s p r e c e d e n c e o v e r any other r e l a t i o n s h i p ( a t the village

l e v e l , of c o u r s e ) f o r the lower c a s t e but not vice versa.

Just as the father-son relationship i s cold, distant, and

f o r m a l so the intercaste relationship i s cold, distant, and

formal. As the f a t h e r - s o n r e l a t i o n s h i p appears t o be asymmetri-

c a l so the intercaste relationship appears.


59

SOLIDARITY STRUCTURES WITHIN THE JAJMANI SYSTEM

The second t y p e o f r e l a t i o n s h i p a t t h e v i l l a g e level

w h i c h i n v o l v e s t h e head o f t h e h o u s e h o l d a c t i n g as t h e r e p r e -

s e n t a t i v e of the u n i t i s the jajman-kamin relationship. This

r e l a t i o n s h i p i s i n content e s s e n t i a l l y an economic one—

a l t h o u g h i t does have d e f i n i t e p o l i t i c a l o v e r t o n e s - - i n which

the kamin i s i n an i n f e r i o r and dependent p o s i t i o n relative

to the j a j m a n . The j a j m a n i s y s t e m w i l l be d i s c u s s e d more

fully In the next c h a p t e r , but i t i s n e c e s s a r y t o l o o k at

the r e l a t i o n s h i p i n terms o f t h e s o l i d a r i t y structures now.

The r e l a t i o n s h i p I s d e f i n e d by t h e t y p e o f s e r v i c e which

i s exchanged between j a j m a n and kamin h o u s e h o l d s . As I n t h e

c a s t e o r i e n t e d r e l a t i o n s h i p s t h e p o i n t o f c o n t a c t i s t h e heads

of t h e two h o u s e h o l d s , b u t i n some ways t h e r e l a t i o n s h i p can

be r e g a r d e d as an u n w r i t t e n c o n t r a c t between two households

so t h a t t h e r e l a t i o n s h i p can e x i s t t h r o u g h more t h a n one

generation. I t i s up t o each head o f h o u s e h o l d t o see that

the terms o f t h e agreement a r e l i v e d up t o . I n t h e case o f

the j o i n t h o u s e h o l d — b r o t h e r s a f t e r the death of the father--

it i s t h e e l d e s t b r o t h e r who as head o f h o u s e h o l d assumes t h e

r i g h t s and d u t i e s o f t h e p r e v i o u s l y e x i s t i n g agreement. If

the j a j m a n h o u s e h o l d i s s m a l l and t h e kamin h o u s e h o l d i s l a r g e

i t may be t h a t t h e s e r v i c e s o f o n l y p a r t o f t h e kamin h o u s e h o l d

are needed. I n t h a t case t h e unneeded p o r t i o n o f t h e joint

h o u s e h o l d w i l l have t o f o r m a new relationship with another

jajman. The s i t u a t i o n may, o f c o u r s e , be r e v e r s e d .


60

The content of the jajman-kamin relationship is very

similar to that of the father-son relationship. The kamin

is in an i n f e r i o r p o s i t i o n w i t h respect to the jajman because

of h i s caste and o c c u p a t i o n , and t h e b e h a v i o u r patterns mani-

fested in interaction patterns between the two are very

similar to those between father and s o n . The k a m i n always

shows a great deal of r e s p e c t , deference and o b e d i e n c e to his

jajman. The j a j m a n i n turn expects this and so l o n g as that

kind of behaviour is forthcoming treats the k a m i n as though

he w e r e a s o n .

The r e l a t i o n s h i p for the jajman is not a s t r o n g one just

as it is not for the father in the father-son relationship.

For the kamin the relationship with his jajman may t a k e prece-

dence over any of the others he m i g h t form at the village level.

For example the kamin w i l l observe his o b l i g a t i o n s to his jajman

before he observes the o b l i g a t i o n s he h a s to h i s caste panchayat

SUMMARY

Solidarity structures at the village level operate to

order the s i g n i f i c a n t r e l a t i o n s h i p s - - i n t r a and intercaste

and j a j m a n - k a m i n r e l a t i o n s h i p s — i n a manner v e r y like the

f a t h e r - s o n and b r o t h e r - b r o t h e r r e l a t i o n s h i p s at the household

level. The v i l l a g e c a n be v i e w e d almost as the household

writ large with e a c h h o u s e h o l d as an i n d i v i d u a l w r i t large.


61

FOOTNOTES

1
T h e f o l l o w i n g books and a r t i c l e s were particularly
useful f o rthe w r i t i n g of t h i s chapter:

(a) A l a n R. R e a l s , Gopalpur (New Y o r k , 1 9 6 2 ) , C h a p t e r I I .

(b) G. M o r r i s C a r s t a i r s , T h e T w i c e B o r n (Bloomington,
1962) , C h a p t e r s 3 a n d 4.

(c) M. L. C o r m a c k , She Who R i d e s a Peacock (New Y o r k ,


1961) .
(d) J o h n T. H i t c h c o c k , "The R a j p u t s o f K h a l a p u r , I n d i a , "
S i x C u l t u r e s , S t u d i e s o f C h i l d R e a r i n g (New Y o r k ,
1963) •
(e) D a v i d G. M a n d e l b a u m , " F a m i l y , J a t i , C a s t e , " S t r u c t u r e
and Change - I n d i a n S o c i e t y , e d . S i n g e r a n d Cohn
( C h i c a g o , 1968).

(f) M a n d e l b a u m , "The F a m i l y - I n d i a , " I n t r o d u c t i o n t o


C i v i l i z a t i o n of India (Chicago).

(g) J o a n M e n c h e r , " G r o w i n g Up - S o u t h M a l a b a r , " Human


O r g a n i z a t i o n 22 : 54-65.

(h) Leigh Minturn, "Child Training," S i x Cultures,


S t u d i e s o f C h i l d R e a r i n g , e d . B e a t r i c e B. W h i t i n g
(New Y o r k , 1 9 6 3 ) •

(i) R. K. N a r a y a n , T h e B a c h e l o r of Arts (East Lansing,


1954) .
M a r i o n J . L e v y , J r . , The S t r u c t u r e o f S o c i e t y (New J e r s e y ,
1 9 5 2 ) , p . 350.
3
Ibid.
4
Ibid., p . 352.
Carstairs, op_. c i t . , p p . 67-8.

^ I b i d . , p . 69 .
7
P a n c h a y a t l i t e r a l l y t r a n s l a t e d means C o u n c i l o f F i v e b u t
g e n e r a l l y i n c l u d e s a l l h o u s e h o l d heads o f t h e c a s t e i n q u e s t i o n .
A l t h o u g h I s h a l l d i s c u s s t h e j a j m a n i s y s t e m more f u l l y i n
a l a t e r c h a p t e r , I s h a l l o u t l i n e b r i e f l y I t s n a t u r e now. I n t h e
j a j m a n i system t h e r e i s a jajman (patron) and a s u r r o u n d i n g
I '' I I
'!;(•; j ;i J iii:j | i i ; :
: I 'J i )
1
I • >V; I 1 • • r '

] ' I. i ;:;; 11; :j. I i


iiii,; w i 1f r'f';; | n..' <' 1. i, <, 1.; i' - '
l:'. i) 1 !.
•, , r i i, j 1111 <,', \ i. \ > r< 1 ! ."'I') " i (.J f! • 1, i i i
1

t /1 i u t ] Iv W fl': 11 ' <l*i' '• o i ' i. I i' ' <


CHAPTER IV

The Structure of Economic A l l o c a t i o n ^

The processes of e c o n o m i c a l l o c a t i o n m u s t be divided

into two broad categories: the processes of p r o d u c t i o n and

the processes of consumption. This breakdown i s necessary

because the u n i t which i s involved i n production is not

exactly the same as the unit which consumes.

D E F I N I T I O N OF ECONOMIC A L L O C A T I O N

I shall define economic allocation following Levy,

"Economic a l l o c a t i o n i n c o n c r e t e social structures may be

defined as the d i s t r i b u t i o n of the g o o d s and services making

up the income of the concrete structure concerned and of the

g o o d s and e f f o r t s m a k i n g up the output of that structure

among t h e various members o f t h e structure and among the

members o f the structural unit and other structural units


2

with which I t i s i n contact i n these respects." The sub-

structure of economic p r o d u c t i o n i n terms of this definition

includes a l l the structures f r o m whose o p e r a t i o n goods and

services accrue to the concrete structures concerned. The

substructure of consumption includes a l l structures whose

operation ensures the a l l o c a t i o n o f goods and services to the

appropriate concrete structures.

THE SUBSTRUCTURE OF ECONOMIC PRODUCTION

In d e s c r i b i n g the substructure of economic p r o d u c t i o n the

sorts of q u e s t i o n s w h i c h m u s t be answered are who does what to

63
64

p r o d u c e w h i c h goods and s e r v i c e s . The f i r s t thing that needs

t o be e s t a b l i s h e d i s the n a t u r e of t h e c o n c r e t e production

unit. I t i s not t h e h o u s e h o l d b e c a u s e i t i s n o t l a r g e enough

to d i r e c t l y produce a l l i t consumes. H o u s e h o l d s are bound by

t h e i r c a s t e t o p r o d u c e o n l y one k i n d o f good or s e r v i c e which

i s exchanged f o r the o t h e r n e c e s s a r y goods and s e r v i c e s . And

it I s n o t the v i l l a g e as a whole w h i c h a c t s as a m i n i m a l p r o -

d u c t i o n u n i t because t h e r e are s e v e r a l p r o d u c t i o n u n i t s coexisting

I n the v i l l a g e . ( A l t h o u g h the v i l l a g e can be c o n s i d e r e d as a

unit with respect t o the s e r v i c e s r e n d e r e d by such c a s t e groups

as the s w e e p e r s , this is really a rather special case.)

The b a s i c p r o d u c t i o n u n i t i s on a s c a l e i n terms of

numbers o f i n d i v i d u a l s i n v o l v e d somewhere between the household

and the v i l l a g e . I t I s a m u l t i h o u s e h o l d , m u l t i c a s t e group w i t h

one o f t h e h o u s e h o l d s r e c o g n i z e d by the r e s t as m a n a g e r i a l and

the r e s t of t h e h o u s e h o l d s r a n k e d a c c o r d i n g t o t h e i r c a s t e and

c o n t r i b u t i o n s t o the g r o u p . These groups as u n i t s o f p r o d u c -

tion exist o v e r a l l of I n d i a and c e r t a i n l y t h r o u g h o u t northern

India. T h i s u n i t has many names d e p e n d i n g upon the language

of the a r e a , b u t , i n general, at l e a s t s i n c e W i s e r ' s 1936 study,

The H i n d u J a j m a n i S y s t e m , i t has been known as the jajmani

system.

THE JAJMANI SYSTEM


The j a j m a n i system comes i n t o e x i s t e n c e because o f the

caste system. H o u s e h o l d s are c o n f i n e d t o c a r r y i n g out only

one o f the t a s k s of p r o d u c t i o n because o f t h e i r c a s t e . As a


65

result a fairly elaborate system of reciprocal exchanges

develops. Each h o u s e h o l d depends upon t h e p r o d u c t i o n o f

other households a n d some k i n d o f s y s t e m m u s t be d e v e l o p e d

to ensure r e c i p r o c i t y between households. The resulting

system i s the jajmani system. Each h o u s e h o l d has a l l t h e

o t h e r h o u s e h o l d s i n t h e s y s t e m as a j a j m a n - - i n o t h e r w o r d s ,

each h o u s e h o l d i n t h e system s e r v e s a l l t h e o t h e r h o u s e h o l d s .

And i n turn a l lthe other households serve a single household.

Thus e a c h h o u s e h o l d s h o u l d r e c e i v e a l lthat i s necessary to

ensure survival. F o r example, t h e p o t t e r makes p o t s f o r a

group composed o f h o u s e h o l d s o f other castes which i n turn

supply the potter with t h e goods t h e y p r o d u c e . Each potter

is a member o f a s i m i l a r group. However, j u s t as i t I s c a s t e

t h a t makes t h i s elaborate system n e c e s s a r y , so i t i s c a s t e that

causes t h i s s y s t e m t o be a n y t h i n g b u t t h e e g a l i t a r i a n model I t

seems.

To show how t h e j a j m a n i system a c t u a l l y works I shall

make u s e o f t h e d a t a w h i c h O s c a r L e w i s p r o v i d e s I n h i s 1958
4
study of the v i l l a g e o f Rampur i n U t t a r Pradesh.

1. The J a j m a n i S y s t e m as i t O p e r a t e s i n Rampur

There a r e 150 households i n residence i n Rampur village.

There are twelve castes represented i n the v i l l a g e with the

following distribution: "Seventy-eight J a t i f a m i l i e s , fifteen

Brahmin, t w e n t y Chamar (leatherworker), t e n Bhangi (sweeper),

s e v e n Kumhar (potter), five Jhinvar (water c a r r i e r ) , four

Dhobi (washerman), f o u r K h a t i (carpenter), three Nai (barber),


66

two Chip! (calicao printer or t a i l o r ) , one L o h a r (blacksmith),

and one B a n i y a (merchant)." T h u s 52% o f t h e h o u s e h o l d s i n

the village are J a t i . ^ This preponderance i s made e v e n greater

when i t i s c o n s i d e r e d that J a t i households a r e on t h e a v e r a g e

larger than the households of other castes. The p e r c e n t a g e o f

Jatis by n u m e r i c a l count i s e x a c t l y 59%. The n e x t three largest

groups account f o r n o t q u i t e 25%. The o t h e r eight castes total

just over 15% of the resident population.

The village o f Rampur i s l o c a t e d i n a n a r e a w h i c h i s

dominated by t h e J a t i caste and t h e v i l l a g e s a r e k n o w n as Jati

villages. In other parts o f t h e U.P. the Rajputs or the Thakurs

are t h e dominant caste and I n s t i l l other areas t h e r e may be

other castes who d o m i n a t e . A t any r a t e t h e t y p i c a l pattern

is f o r one c a s t e to numerically dominate the v i l l a g e . Although

in the J a t i areas o f U.P. one e x p e c t s t h e dominant caste t o be

Jati the presence of other castes i n the v i l l a g e as w e l l as

their n u m b e r s i s n o t n e a r l y as p r e d i c t a b l e . Unlike Rampur

there may be v i l l a g e s i n which there are only two o r t h r e e

households o f B r a h m i n s a n d C h a m a r s a n d more D h o b i s , Bhangis,

and Lohars.

Not only do t h e J a t i s dominate n u m e r i c a l l y i n Rampur,

they a l s o own o v e r 90% o f t h e 784 acres of land w i t h i n the

boundaries of the v i l l a g e i n c l u d i n g the land on w h i c h t h e vil-

lage residences are b u i l t . Landholdings vary i n size, and

twelve of the J a t i h o u s e h o l d s depend c o m p l e t e l y upon sources

other than the land f o r their livelihood. Although this


67

situation i s not too unusual today, i t should be pointed out

that i n the past and f o r many v i l l a g e s today there is no

outside source of income. There are an additional 30 house-

holds, some o f w h o s e members a c q u i r e Income f r o m n o n v i l l a g e

sources. There a r e , i n f a c t , only 36 Jati households which

rely completely on the land they own for their livelihood.

Among t h e other castes the percentage of those relying upon

outside sources f o r income i s q u i t e h i g h . Indeed, there are

few of the o t h e r c a s t e s who rely completely upon s o u r c e s of

income w i t h i n the village. For both Jatis and non-Jatis this

is a r e l a t i v e l y new phenomenon. Previously virtually the only

source of income l a y w i t h i n the village and i t Is i n this con-

text that I shall examine the jajmani system, f o r i t i s only

in this context t h a t the j a j m a n i system can actually work.

As l o n g as h o u s e h o l d s m u s t l o o k i n w a r d s towards the village

t h e y must work w i t h i n t h e system.

As I pointed out earlier i n the chapter, the jajmani

system i n theory i s a set of r e c i p r o c a l exchanges between

h o u s e h o l d s a l l o f whom i n c a r r y i n g o u t their daily tasks pro-

vide each other w i t h the goods and services necessary for

survival. Each household serves a l l the other households and

all o f them s e r v e each household. When b e i n g served the

household i s known as jajman and when s e r v i n g t h e household

is known as k a m i n . T h e s e two t e r m s mean r o u g h l y master and

servant respectively, so t h a t an individual household should

be both m a s t e r and servant to a l l the other households in the

group. This however, i s n o t h i n g like what t h e system really


68

is. Were i t s o t h e k i n d s o f r e l a t i o n s h i p s between households

would more c l o s e l y resemble those o f a group of s i b l i n g s .

There would b e some g i v e a n d t a k e , some semblence of equality,

m u t u a l r e s p e c t f o r one a n o t h e r , e t c .

Par from b e i n g a w e l l - b a l a n c e d system f o r the production

and d i s t r i b u t i o n o f goods and s e r v i c e s , i t i s rather a repressive

and coercive system i n which c e r t a i n households are able t o

almost c o m p l e t e l y dominate other households. I t resembles,

in f a c t , the father-son relationship quite closely from a l l

Indications. Ideally the jajman-kamin relationship is a

voluntary one i n w h i c h each of the households i s able t o opt

out s h o u l d i t be f e l t necessary. The j a j m a n h a s t h e r i g h t t o

sever the r e l a t i o n s h i p s h o u l d the kamin not p r o v i d e adequate

service and t h e kamin has a s i m i l a r r i g h t should the jajman

fail to live up t o h i s o b l i g a t i o n s . In reality severing the

relationship i s more p o s s i b l e than probable f o r the household

which i s i n the p o s i t i o n o f kamin. In reality each household

is k n o w n i n t h e v i l l a g e as e i t h e r j a j m a n h o u s e h o l d o r as a

kamin household. A household i n t h e v i l l a g e i s known t o a l l

other households as e i t h e r jajman o r kamin and t h i s i s a f i x e d

status. Those h o u s e h o l d s which a r e k n o w n as j a j m a n households

are those which own l a n d - - t h o s e t h a t do n o t own l a n d a r e known

as k a m i n s . In addition to this 'either/or' ranking, households

are ranked w i t h i n either group. The p o o r e r J a t i households

(poorer g e n e r a l l y because t h e y own o n l y s m a l l amounts o f l a n d )

are jajmans but not n e a r l y t o t h e same e x t e n t a s t h e w e a l t h y


69

Jati households. I n some w a y s t h e y are considered jajmans

only because they a r e . o f the same c a s t e as the wealthy jaj-

mans. By the same t o k e n some k a m i n s a r e more d e p e n d e n t than

others on their jajmans and t o the extent t h a t they are depen-

dent they take on a g r e a t e r amount o f t h e quality of 'kamin-

ness . ' The kamin i s i n r e a l i t y the servant of the jajman and

the extent t o w h i c h he m u s t be just a servant d e p e n d s on his

importance to the jajman.

A test of the m u t u a l i t y of the jajman-kamin relationship

and the respect each has f o r the other i s to observe the

n u m b e r o f c a s t e s w h i c h any one caste serves and the number

of castes which are i n turn servants to that caste. This is


g

one of the aspects which Wiser looked a t and i t is obvious

that there are some c a s t e s w h i c h o n l y s e r v e and are not served

in turn. These i n c l u d e the v e r y low castes which are responsib

for carrying out the tasks which the h i g h e r castes designate

as b e i n g ritually polluting (e.g., removing waste of either

human o r a n i m a l origin from the village confines). These

castes are jajmans t o no one and they are kamins to a l l . They

must p e r f o r m a l l the services necessary for their survival for

themselves and they must s t i l l depend upon the village (e.g.,

the jajmans) f o r g i f t s of food.

The role of kamin i s , then, essentially a servile one,

but I t i s a matter of degree--that i s , one has more o r less

of the quality of 'kaminness' which d i c t a t e s the appropriate

pattern of b e h a v i o r w i t h the jajman. The variation extends


70

from a r e l a t i o n s h i p which has elements o f e q u a l i t y about i t

to a relationship with i m p l i c a t i o n s of complete i n e q u a l i t y .

At one p o l e t h e j a j m a n - k a m i n r e l a t i o n s h i p may approach the

ideal and a t t h e o t h e r pole i t may approach very nearly the

opposite of the i d e a l . The j a j m a n - k a m i n r e l a t i o n s h i p a p p r o a c h e s

the i d e a l when t h e two h o u s e h o l d s i n v o l v e d are of roughly the

same s t a t u s i n the r i t u a l hierarchy and each o f f e r s t o the

other what i s c o n s i d e r e d b y e a c h t o be a n i m p o r t a n t service,

and i t i s f u r t h e s t when t h e t w o h o u s e h o l d s are separated by

great ritual distance a n d when t h e n e e d o f one f o r t h e other

is greater than the reverse. It is difficult, i f not impos-

sible, to generalize about which castes will or w i l l not enter

into a jajman-kamin r e l a t i o n s h i p with a modicam o f e q u a l i t y .

One m u s t f i r s t e s t a b l i s h t h e c a s t e of the jajmans i n the vil-

lage. This is fairly easily done by a s k i n g any o f t h e r e s i d e n t s

what k i n d o f v i l l a g e i ti s . I n Rampur t h e a n s w e r w o u l d be that

It i s a Jati village. Most o f the v i l l a g e s i n the v i c i n i t y of

Rampur are J a t i villages. Further t o t h e e a s t , where most o f

the village land i s owned b y R a j p u t s , the v i l l a g e s a r e known

as Rajput villages and t h e R a j p u t s m u s t be c o n s i d e r e d the j a j -

mans i n t h o s e villages.

I n Rampur Jatis are not very h i g h l y ranked i n the ritual

hierarchy. Their patterns of behaviour preclude high ritual

status (based on t h e t y p e of food they e a t a n d i t s mode o f

preparation as w e l l a s t h e f a c t that they a l l o w widow remar-

riage. Their jajman status i s based s o l e l y on t h e f a c t that


71

they own the village lands. Thus t h e y are able to form a

relationship with some o f t h e h i g h e r artisan castes which

is based on r e c i p r o c a l n e e d s and i s not over coloured by

ritual differences. T h i s w o u l d be particularly true with

respect to the Brahmin p r i e s t . The Rajput jajmans to the

east a r e much h i g h e r on the ritual h i e r a r c h y and the ritual

d i s t a n c e b e t w e e n them and n e a r l y a l l of the other castes

(perhaps w i t h the exception of the Brahmin p r i e s t s ) prevents

to a l a r g e degree any approximation to the ideal jajman-

kamin relationship.

In a d d i t i o n t o the r e l a t i v e position i n the ritual hier-

archy as a method of d e t e r m i n i n g the amount o f e q u a l i t y there

will be i n the jajman-kamin r e l a t i o n s h i p , one must a l s o con-

sider the size of the resident population of each c a s t e as

well as the fact t h a t some c a s t e s p e r f o r m a fairly specialized

task. The Kumhars are a typical example of t h i s combination

of f a c t o r s . Everyone i n the village needs c l a y pots for con-


9
tainers o f one sort or a n o t h e r . There i s , however, a definite

limit to the number o f p o t s t h a t the v i l l a g e can use. As long

as there are o n l y enough or not q u i t e e n o u g h Kumhar households

to meet t h e n e e d s of the village their s e r v i c e s are In demand.

The other castes do not have a c h o i c e as t o whom t h e y will

patronize. I f there i s a dire shortage the village may even

make e f f o r t s to persuade another, o u t s i d e r Kumhar household

to come l i v e i n the village. Various kinds of advantages will


72

be o f f e r e d t o get them t o l e a v e t h e v i l l a g e t h e y are already

s e r v i n g - - t h e p r i m e one w i l l be t h a t t h e j a j m a n - k a m i n r e l a t i o n -

s h i p w i l l have l e s s emphasis on s e r v i l i t y . I f t h e r e a r e more

Kumhar h o u s e h o l d s t h a n t h e v i l l a g e has needs t h e n t h e Kumhars

are i n a more d i f f i c u l t p o s i t i o n . They have s e v e r a l courses

o f a c t i o n open t o them--none o f w h i c h a r e v e r y a p p e a l i n g i n

t h e eyes o f t h e Kumhars. The f i r s t o p t i o n i s t h a t each house-

hold w i l l c o n t i n u e t o make p o t s b u t I n s m a l l e r q u a n t i t i e s thus

r e d u c i n g t h e i r income. The second o p t i o n i s t h a t some o f the

households cease t o make p o t s and become t e n a n t s of the jajmans

or worse (and p r o b a b l y more l i k e l y ) l a n d l e s s labourers. This

course of a c t i o n i s l i k e l y t o be r e s i s t e d because i t w o u l d l o w e r

t h e i r o v e r a l l status i n t h e eyes o f t h e o t h e r c a s t e s - - i t would

lower the s t a t u s even o f t h o s e who a r e s t i l l m a k i n g p o t s . The

third alternative is f o r some o f t h e h o u s e h o l d s t o l e a v e the

v i l l a g e i n s e a r c h o f o t h e r v i l l a g e s w h i c h do not have an o v e r

supply of p o t t e r s . T h i s i s u n d e s i r a b l e b e c a u s e i t means leaving

b e h i n d e s t a b l i s h e d r e l a t i o n s h i p s w i t h f a m i l y , f r i e n d s and p o l i t i -

c a l and economic p a t r o n s . There are seven Kumhar h o u s e h o l d s in

Rampur. I do not have any i n f o r m a t i o n about t h e d e s i r a b l e (from

t h e Kumhar v i e w p o i n t ) h o u s e h o l d r a t i o , but I would s u s p e c t that

i n Rampur the Kumhars w o u l d l i k e t o be l e s s numerous.

The Chamars are a n o t h e r e x a m p l e . T h e i r t r a d i t i o n a l occupa-

t i o n i s t h a t o f r e m o v i n g dead a n i m a l s from the s t r e e t s and

fields of the v i l l a g e . T h e i r income i s d e r i v e d from t h e p r o -

d u c t s w h i c h they can make from the dead a n i m a l s " ^ ( e . g . , leather


73

buckets f o r the P e r s i a n water wheels, sandals, traces for

bullocks, etc.), the meat o f t h e dead a n i m a l s as w e l l as a

certain amount o f t h e agricultural produce of the village at

harvest time. The Chamars a r e a very low caste group. (In

some a r e a s they are not part of the caste system being regarded

as untouchables.) In each v i l l a g e the needs for this kind of

occupation are small, only enough t o support a couple of house-

holds. I n Rampur t h e r e are twenty Chamar h o u s e h o l d s . This

is o b v i o u s l y more t h a n i s needed so t h a t they have been forced

into one of the three alternatives suggested f o r the Kumhars

above. They have n o t moved o u t of the village because a l l of

the other villages i n the a r e a have the same p r o b l e m . There

are just too many h o u s e h o l d s f o r them t o s p l i t up the a v a i l a b l e

income. Thus t h e y have had t o become t h e servants and part

time field hands f o r the Jati farmers who have need for their

labour. Because there are s o many o f t h e m t h e y h a v e no real

b a r g a i n i n g power w i t h i n the jajmani system. 1 1


A caste only has

b a r g a i n i n g p o w e r when i t h a s a l t e r n a t i v e ways o f securing the

requisite income f o r survival.

Aside from the ritual d i s t a n c e between the K u m h a r s who are

a fairly high caste group and the C h a m a r s who are definitely

low c a s t e , the Kumhars have a b e t t e r p o s i t i o n w i t h i n the jajmani

system because they are not tied to a single jajman. Rather

they serve s e v e r a l jajmans and can play the jajmans off one

against the other. I f they are not t r e a t e d t h e way they feel

they should be by a particular jajman, they can simply stop


making pots f o r the household. C h a m a r s a r e much more likely

to be t i e d to a p a r t i c u l a r jajman.

Thus t h e q u a l i t y of 'kaminness' depends upon the c a s t e

of t h e j a j m a n and t h e c a s t e o f t h e k a m i n as w e l l as t h e size

of the caste to which the kamin b e l o n g s .

Just as t h e r e a r e d e g r e e s of 'kaminness' so t h e r e a r e

degrees of 'jajmanness.' A l l of the J a t i households i n the

village partake of t h i s quality. None o f t h e o t h e r castes,

including the Brahmin, would be c o n s i d e r e d as j a j m a n s . A l l

Jati households i n the v i l l a g e are e n t i t l e d t o equal r e s p e c t

by a l l of the o t h e r h o u s e h o l d s , but t h i s i s o n l y by virtue

of b e l o n g i n g t o the J a t i caste. I t i s not d i f f i c u l t f o r the

individuals living i n the v i l l a g e to determine which of the

jajmans are 'hangers-on' and w h i c h are not. There are b i g

jajmans and little jajmans.

The J a t i s a r e t h e j a j m a n s by virtue of the land which

they own. T h o s e who own t h e most l a n d are those which have

more o f t h e q u a l i t y of 'jajmanness.' Of t h e 78 Jati house-

holds I n Rampur o n l y 28 h a v e more t h a n t e n a c r e s o f l a n d . I

would suggest that those households which own less than ten

acres of land are the hangers-on because these households

probably do n o t h a v e s u f f i c i e n t s u r p l u s after feeding them-

selves and m e e t i n g r i t u a l obligations t o command m o r e than


12
minimally the s e r v i c e s of the other castes. They w i l l have

very little basis for reciprocation with other castes.


75

Of t h e 2 8 h o u s e h o l d s owning more t h a n 1 0 a c r e s , there

are 14 h o u s e h o l d s w h i c h own b e t w e e n 1 0 a n d 14 a c r e s , s i x

which own b e t w e e n 14 a n d 1 8 a c r e s , t h r e e w h i c h own between

18 and 22 a c r e s , t h r e e which own b e t w e e n 2 2 a n d 25 a c r e s , a n d


13

two w h i c h own more t h a n 2 5 a c r e s . One o f t h e l a t t e r two

owns j u s t over 50 acres. Only those jajman with considerable

l a n d h o l d i n g s c a n command t h e s e r v i c e s o f l a r g e numbers o f

kamins. A household which owns 2 5 a c r e s r e q u i r e s the services

of a l a r g e number o f l a b o u r e r s . These h o u s e h o l d s require the

services o f o t h e r c a s t e s t o meet t h e i r needs. I f there are

enough h o u s e h o l d s involved then the i n d i v i d u a l castes involved

will h a v e e n o u g h w o r k t o do a n d r e m a i n t i e d to the entire group.

For e x a m p l e t h e j a j m a n may h a v e a t t a c h e d t o h i m e n o u g h house-

holds to require the f u l l - t i m e services o f a Kumhar h o u s e h o l d .

This household w i l l be l o y a l t o t h e group because they provide

it with the services i t needs t o s u r v i v e . A s we s h a l l see i n

the next chapter i t i s t o the p o l i t i c a l advantage o f the jajman

to have a l a r g e following o f kamins who a r e l o y a l t o him and t o

the rest o f t h e group. Thus t h e l a r g e r jajmans w i l l t r yto

increase the size of t h e i r following. The l a r g e r the following

the more p o l i t i c a l p o w e r t h e j a j m a n h a s a n d t h e more political

p o w e r he h a s t h e e a s i e r i t i s t o a c q u i r e more l a n d . As c a n be

seen t h e process o f c u m u l a t i v e ( c i r c u l a r ) causation I s a t work

in t h e economic activity of the jajman households.

There are 28 households i n Rampur w h i c h could form the

nucleus o f a jajman-kamin group. Not a l l o f t h e s e households


76

have done s o . There just a r e n o t enough kamins t o go around.

Only t h e l a r g e s t land owners w i l l be a b l e t o d e v e l o p this

kind o f group. The s m a l l e r landowners are not l e f t out i n

the cold, rather they j o i n with the larger landowner to form

a rather c o h e s i v e economic unit which shares the services of

the other castes. Thus w i t h i n a n y one v i l l a g e there w i l l be

several of these units consisting of the jajman, other

cooperating, lesser j a j m a n , and a s u r r o u n d i n g group o f kamins.

The j a j m a n a s s u m e s w h a t may b e t e r m e d a managerial role which,

as I m e n t i o n e d i n t h e c h a p t e r on s o l i d a r i t y structures, takes

on some o f t h e a t t r i b u t e s of the father role i n the household.

A l t h o u g h much o f t h e a c t u a l f a r m i n g i s done b y J a t i households,

some o f t h e k a m i n households w i l l provide additional labour

either as t e n a n t s o r a s d a y l a b o u r e r s . The r e l a t i o n s h i p between

these households and t h e j a j m a n w i l l be c l o s e r t h a n t h e r e l a t i o n -

ship with any o f t h e o t h e r kamins because farming i s the primary

activity of t h e group. The n e x t closest ring o f kamin house-

holds includes t h o s e who p r o v i d e g o o d s a n d s k i l l s which neither

the jajman nor the labouring households p o s s e s s o r do n o t h a v e

the time t o pursue. T h i s group includes the smith, the c a r -


ill

penter, the potter, the t a i l o r , etc. The o u t e r m o s t ring of

kamin households which surrounds the jajman c o n s i s t of castes

who f o l l o w occupations which are r i t u a l l y impossible f o r the

jajman and t h e o t h e r kamins. This l o tincludes such o c c u p a t i o n s

as t h e b a r b e r , t h e w a t e r c a r r i e r , and t h e washerman.

All of these castes, with t h e j a j m a n o p e r a t i n g as a manager

at t h e c e n t e r , work t o g e t h e r i n such f a s h i o n t h a t their needs,


77

both r i t u a l l y and physically, a r e more o r l e s s satisfied.

Their needs w i l l be m o r e s a t i s f i e d i f t h e y a r e h i g h e r on

the p r i o r i t y list and less i f t h e y a r e low on t h e list.

The members o f t h i s s y s t e m assume p r i o r i t y i n the order that

I described immediately a b o v e when o u t l i n i n g their respective

contributions to the g r o u p — t h e jajman as m a n a g e r , t h e

l a b o u r e r as farmer, the s e r v i c e castes for their skills,

and t h e s e r v a n t c a s t e s f o r p e r f o r m i n g r i t u a l l y polluting

jobs.

Not a l l of the households i n the v i l l a g e are eligible

f o r membership i n the j a j m a n i system. The Chamars and the

Bhangis a r e o u t c a s t e s o r u n t o u c h a b l e s and h e n c e can never

become p a r t of the system. They a r e , i n e f f e c t , kamins to

the v i l l a g e as a u n i t . They s e r v i c e the e n t i r e village, but

do n o t r e c e i v e services i n return. What f o o d t h e y r e c e i v e i s

more i n t h e n a t u r e o f c h a r i t y t h a n as s o m e t h i n g due for serv-

ices rendered. Failure to perform this service can and does

lead t o such punishment as a s e v e r e beating.

The jajmani system as d e s c r i b e d above, then, i s a system

which o p e r a t e s t o e n s u r e t h e p r o d u c t i o n o f goods and services

needed t o s u s t a i n the i n d i v i d u a l households within the village.

In saying that the jajmani system i s the b a s i c production unit,

I am not saying that the unit is totally self-sufficient.

There a r e some i t e m s w h i c h cannot e v e n be produced by the

village as a w h o l e l e t a l o n e by t h e j a j m a n i system. Items

s u c h as s a l t h a v e t o be p u r c h a s e d outside of the village,


78

b u t by and l a r g e e v e r y t h i n g n e e d e d by t h e u n i t could be

produced by i t s members.

The jajmani system i s a r a t h e r u n i q u e way o f h a n d l i n g

the p r o d u c t i o n needs o f a s o c i e t y . I t seems t o h a v e developed

in response t o t h e needs o f a s o c i e t y which has very rigid

caste boundaries. There m u s t b e some k i n d of structure which

can c o o r d i n a t e t h e e f f o r t s of a l l the castes. That I ti s

r a t h e r unique c a n be s e e n w h e n i t i s c o m p a r e d w i t h other

agrarian societies . Normally the production unit i n other

societies i s the household. There seems t o b e more division

of labour w i t h i n the household and n o t q u i t e s o much between

households. A l l households carry o u t r o u g h l y t h e same tasks

necessary f o r s u r v i v a l r a t h e r than d i v i d i n g up t h e t a s k s

between households.

THE SUBSTRUCTURE OF ECONOMIC CONSUMPTION

I have s a i d above t h a t the basic unit of production In

the Indian v i l l a g e i s a group of households consisting of a

j a j m a n h o u s e h o l d and a v a r y i n g number o f a s s o c i a t e d kamin

households. The c o m b i n e d activities o f t h e kamin households,

under t h e management of the jajman produce the r e q u i s i t e

goods and s e r v i c e s t o meet a t l e a s t t h e minimum r e q u i r e m e n t s

of t h e whole group. Distribution of the produce occurs i n

one o f two ways: goods f l o w I n t o t h e hands o f t h e manager

for future redistribution among t h e m e m b e r s ; a n d / o r , s e r v i c e s

and goods a r e t r a d e d between t h e kamin households as w e l l as

between t h e j a j m a n and kamins.


79

The substructure of consumption i s ,like the substructure

of production, complicated. I n some I n s t a n c e s i t i s t h e

jajman-kamin group which i s the basic consumption u n i t and

in other cases I t I s the i n d i v i d u a l household. I t Is possible

to differentiate these instances on t h e b a s i s of the direction

and flow o f t h e goods and s e r v i c e s produced. I n o t h e r words

the substructure o f consumption i s tied Intimately with the

process of d i s t r i b u t i o n . Those goods and s e r v i c e s which are

produced by kamins and c o l l e c t e d by t h e j a j m a n t o be distri-

buted at a l a t e r d a t e t o o t h e r kamins are instances of the

whole group acting as a c o n s u m p t i o n u n i t . I t I s the jajman

who d e c i d e s w h i c h h o u s e h o l d w i l l g e t how much o f t h e t o t a l

product. This occurs p r i m a r i l y with respect t o t h e consump-

tion of agricultural products.

When K a m i n h o u s e h o l d s e x c h a n g e g o o d s among t h e m s e l v e s

with t h e j a j m a n as i n t e r m e d i a r y i t I s the household which i s

acting as t h e c o n s u m p t i o n u n i t because i t i s the household

w h i c h makes t h e c h o i c e as t o what i t w i l l t a k e f o r consump-

tion purposes i n exchange f o r i t s products — in other words,

when t h e d e c i s i o n rests with the household.

It can perhaps be s a i d that this i s an u n n e c e s s a r y distinc-

tion, but the fact that t h e k a m i n h o u s e h o l d may n o t b e g r a n t e d

as much f o r c o n s u m p t i o n a s i t h a s p r o d u c e d makes t h e d i s t i n c t i o n

warranted. So l o n g a s t h e j a j m a n h a s t h e p o w e r t o f o r c e a sur-

plus from the p r o d u c t i o n u n i t I think I t i s a necessary dis-

tinction. The s i z e of the surplus which t h e j a j m a n keeps back


80

depends upon h i s power i n the village as w e l l as w h e t h e r or

not the kamin h o u s e h o l d s have a v i a b l e alternative (whether

or not there exists the possibility t h a t the kamin household

can enter another production unit).

Generally speaking the s u r p l u s which the jajman i s able

to command i s a v e r y small percentage of the total product of

the p r o d u c t i o n u n i t . The t o t a l product of the p r o d u c t i o n unit

is b a r e l y able to cover the consumption needs of the unit . In

many c a s e s i f there i s a s u r p l u s I t Is only because the con-

sumption u n i t In terms of the individual households is not

granted e v e n t h e minimum. When t h i s happens the individual

household must l o o k e l s e w h e r e f o r the rest of the necessary

income. Often the only course o f a c t i o n i s t o b o r r o w money

from the jajman and this I s one o f t h e most e f f e c t i v e means

at the d i s p o s a l of the jajman to ensure t h a t h i s kamins remain

within his group.

As we shall see i n the following chapter on the s t r u c t u r e

of p o l i t i c a l allocation the s t r u c t u r e of economic allocation

is extremely important i n terms of the decision-making process.

As i n any social system of t h i s nature the separation of eco-

nomic and political allocation can occur only analytically.

C h a n g e s i n any concrete structure w i l l effect other concrete

structures and this i s what I s h a l l t r y t o show i n t h e last

chapter on social change.

To s u m m a r i z e , t h e n , what I have d i s c u s s e d i n t h i s chapter,

an economic s t r u c t u r e has developed which i s designed to


81

overcome a v e r y r i g i d caste s y s t e m such t h a t a l l c a s t e s a r e

a b l e t o more o r l e s s r e c e i v e t h o s e goods and s e r v i c e s neces-

sary f o r s u r v i v a l .
82

FOOTNOTES

"'"Of p a r t i c u l a r u s e in writing this chapter I would


i n c l u d e the f o l l o w i n g :

a) F. G. B a i l e y , C a s t e a n d t h e E c o n o m i c Frontier
( M a n c h e s t e r , 1957), C h a p t e r s 4-7-

b) Thomas 0. B e i d e l m a n , A C o m p a r a t i v e A n a l y s i s o f t h e
J a j m a n i System, Monographs of the A s s o c i a t i o n f o r
A s i a n S t u d i e s (New Y o r k , 1 9 5 9 ) , C h a p t e r s 1 a n d 2.

c) T. S c a r l e t t E p s t e i n , E c o n o m i c D e v e l o p m e n t a n d
S o c i a l C h a n g e - S o u t h I n d i a ( M a n c h e s t e r , 1962) ,
C h a p t e r s 2 a n d 5-

d) M a r i o n J . L e v y , J r . , The S t r u c t u r e of Society
( P r i n c e t o n , 1 9 5 2 ) , C h a p t e r 9.

e) Albert Mayer, P i l o t Project - India, 1958.

f) Kusam N a i r , Blossoms - The Dust (New York, 1962).

g) W. H. W i s e r , The Hindu J a j m a n i System (Lucknow, 1936),


C h a p t e r 1.
2
Levy, op_. c i t . , p . 330.
3
W i s e r , op. c i t .
^Oscar Lewis, V i l l a g e L i f e - Northern India (New York,
1958) .

^ I b i d . , p. 15•

^ J a t i s are a farmer caste. As l a n d o w n e r s t h e y may n o t


have t o work i n the f i e l d s but t h e i r t r a d i t i o n a l o c c u p a t i o n
is that of farming.

L e w i s , op_. c i t . , p. 98.

W i s e r , op_. c i t . , p. 9-

^The K u m h a r s h a v e e n c o u n t e r e d more s e r i o u s d i f f i c u l t i e s
t h a n p o p u l a t i o n p r e s s u r e s . The m a n u f a c t u r e o f b r a s s a n d a l u m -
i n u m p o t s has p u t a l a r g e number o f p o t t e r s o u t o f work. Clay
p o t s a r e n o t n e a r l y as d u r a b l e as b r a s s o r a l u m i n u m .
1 0
T h e Chamars, l i k e the Kumhars, have almost c o m p l e t e l y
l o s t t h e i r t r a d i t i o n a l means o f l i v e l i h o o d . V i l l a g e r s c a n g e t
b e t t e r q u a l i t y cheaper products from the c i t i e s .
83

A l t h o u g h t h e y h a v e no p o w e r w i t h i n t h e j a j m a n i s y s t e m ,
t h e same c a n n o t be s a i d when t h e j a j m a n i s y s t e m b e g i n s t o
b r e a k down. I s h a l l d i s c u s s t h i s more f u l l y i n t h e l a s t
chapter.
12
O u t s i d e sources of income i n c l u d e : T e a c h i n g , army a n d
p o l i c e s e r v i c e , c l e r k s and d r i v e r s f o r t h e p o s t o f f i c e and
n e a r b y m i l l s and f a c t o r i e s , and p e n s i o n s . Obviously not a l l
v i l l a g e s w i l l be n e a r e n o u g h t o s u c h s o u r c e s o f i n c o m e t o t a k e
advantage o f them. Because t r a n s p o r t a t i o n i s extremely l i m i t e d ,
v i l l a g e s w i t h a h i g h p e r c e n t a g e o f o u t s i d e i n c o m e m u s t be l o c a t e d
quite near l a r g e r c i t i e s .
13
Lewis p o i n t s out t h a t v i l l a g e r s r e c k o n a h o u s e h o l d w i t h
o x e n r e q u i r e s 12.5 a c r e s t o l i v e p r o p e r l y . H o w e v e r , 15 h o u s e -
h o l d s h a v e o x e n a n d l a n d h o l d i n g s o f l e s s t h a n 12.5 a c r e s a n d
s t i l l seem t o s u r v i v e . I t i s f o r t h i s reason that I set ten
a c r e s as t h e l o w e r l i m i t .
14 L e w i s , op. c i t . , P P • 97-101.
CHAPTER V

Political Activity Within the V i l l a g e

It will b e my h y p o t h e s i s i n this chapter that although

political activity i s widespread, i tw i l l have as i t s s o l e

object the c o n t r o l of land w i t h i n the v i l l a g e . The i m p l i c a -

tions of this statement are that there i s very little politi-

cal activity among t h e l o w e r castes except as t h e y serve as

instruments o f the upper castes i n the struggle f o rcontrol

over land. I h e s i t a t e to state that there I s no political

activity among t h e l o w e r castes because I would also hypothesize

among t h e l o w e r castes because I would also hypothesize that

the sanskritization process first d e s c r i b e d by S r i n i v a s (cf.

p. ) i s a form o f p o l i t i c a l activity p r a c t i c e d by t h e lower

castes. (I shall deal with this In a later section of this

chapter.)

In the majority of v i l l a g e s i n North I n d i a one c a s t e owns

all or at least a very high percentage of the v i l l a g e lands.

Actually i t I s t h e i n d i v i d u a l h o u s e h o l d w h i c h owns t h e l a n d ,

but o n l y members o f a p a r t i c u l a r caste are allowed t o own

land. The l a n d may b e a l i e n a t e d b y t h e h o u s e h o l d , but p o l i t i -

cal pressure I s s u c h t h a t o n l y members o f t h e l a n d owning caste

will purchase i t . A l i e n a t i o n i s always the l a s t resort, how-

ever, f o r i t means a l o s s o f p o l i t i c a l power. Increase or

decrease of acreage i s an i n d i c a t i o n of either an i n c r e a s e i n

political power o r a decrease.

84
85

Normally a h o u s e h o l d does not c o n t r o l enough l a n d to

h a v e much p o w e r w i t h i n t h e village so t h a t t o g a i n power the

i n d i v i d u a l h o u s e h o l d must combine w i t h other households.

This combination of s e v e r a l households is called a faction

by most w r i t e r s 1
who have observed political activity within

the village. Generally speaking the households which combine

are k i n o f one s o r t or another. Often a sibling group will

form the nucleus of such a combination. These f a c t i o n s are

fairly s t a b l e i n the short run (i.e. five or ten y e a r s ) , but

in the long run there i s considerable shifting of alliances.

In order for a faction to operate s u c c e s s f u l l y i n the long

run i t m u s t meet t h r e e conditions: (1) i t m u s t be sufficiently

cohesive t o a c t as a unit, (2) i t m u s t be l a r g e enough t o act

as a self-sufficient ceremonial g r o u p ; f o r example, i t must

be able t o summon an impressive number o f r e l a t i v e s for a

marriage party, (3) i t must have s u f f i c i e n t economic resources


2
to be independent of other groups.

Of the three c o n d i t i o n s i t i s the first t h a t i s most

difficult t o meet o v e r an extended p e r i o d of time. A faction

may d i s i n t e g r a t e when one of the h o u s e h o l d heads of which i t

Is composed d i e s and his holdings are d i v i d e d up among h i s

sons. Even i f a l l of the sons m a i n t a i n their holdings as a

g r o u p i t means t h a t t h e n u m b e r o f h o u s e h o l d h e a d s w h i c h make

up the group has increased. If this happens w i t h several of

the o r i g i n a l households, the n u m b e r o f h o u s e h o l d s may become

too unwieldy t o be efficient relative to other factions. A


86

second p o s s i b i l i t y whic.i occurs i s that brothers do not main-

tain their property jointly because e i t h e r they or their

respective wives are not able t o get along with one another.

In t h i s event brothers may join different factions.

As the cohesion of the f a c t i o n begins t o b r e a k down i t

b e c o m e s more a n d more d i f f i c u l t t o meet t h e other two con-

ditions necessary for stable factions. Thus t h e r e is a con-

stant formation and reformation of f a c t i o n s w i t h i n the village

in the long run. Political activity takes place within fac-

tions at one level and between f a c t i o n s at another.

Given that c o n d i t i o n s a r e met such t h a t f a c t i o n s are

formed I would hypothesize t h a t the n u m b e r and size of fac-

tions w i t h i n the dominant caste o f the village i s dependent

upon f o u r i n t e r r e l a t e d factors. These f o u r f a c t o r s are as

follows: (1) the size of the caste (number o f households,

average s i z e of household, and p r o p o r t i o n of the total vil-

l a g e p o p u l a t i o n ) , (2) the personalities of the prominent

individuals and the number o f them w i t h i n t h e caste, (3) the

length of r e s i d e n c e w i t h i n the village ( I . e . how long the

h o u s e h o l d s m a k i n g up the f a c t i o n have l i v e d i n the village

and how long the faction, recognized as a f a c t i o n by the

other f a c t i o n s , has been a p a r t of the village political

scene r e l a t i v e to other factions), and (4) the nature of the

issue which i s before the factions. I shall discuss each of

these factors separately below.


87

SIZE OP CASTE

In those v i l l a g e s where the dominant caste controls

the land completely out of p r o p o r t i o n to I t s percentage of

the total population there w i l l be a tendency f o r the caste

t o have fewer f a c t i o n s . The r e s t of the v i l l a g e population

could easily become a t h r e a t i f the c o n t r o l l i n g caste were

not united i n i t s efforts t o keep the r e s t of the village

disunited—disunited at l e a s t with respect to the dominant

caste. In a d d i t i o n , the f a c t that there are fewer households

in the dominant caste means t h a t there i s more l a n d to go

a r o u n d and individual land owners w i l l be the focus of a

rather large jajman-kamin group. Managing this system of

relationships c a n i n some c i r c u m s t a n c e s supercede In impor-

tance i n t r a c a s t e disputes. ( I t should be noted here that i t

can have the o p p o s i t e effect i n that the j a j m a n can use h i s

group of kamins as a p o l i t i c a l f o r c e , and h a v i n g i n hand a

l a r g e group o f kamins certainly m u s t be tempting.)

In those v i l l a g e s w h i c h have a l a r g e p o p u l a t i o n of the

dominant caste there i s less likelihood of unity f o r there

is l e s s need of u n i t y i n the face of the r e s t of the village

population. There is likely t o be a greater spread of wealth

and hence political power between the households of the

dominant caste. There a r e more h o u s e h o l d s competing f o r the

same a m o u n t o f w e a l t h and fewer kamins i n the v i l l a g e to be

u s e d as p o l i t i c a l pawns. In t h i s situation one w o u l d expect


88

a l a r g e r number o f f a c t i o n s - - e a c h f a c t i o n c o n s i s t i n g of a

group of households, usually based on k i n s h i p ties, working

together to protect their interests from the depredations of


3
other similarly constituted groups ( c f . page i n chapter ).

P E R S O N A L I T Y AND NUMBER OP PROMINENT I N D I V I D U A L S WITHIN THE


DOMINANT CASTE

The number o f a b l e and a m b i t i o u s i n d i v i d u a l s within the

village determines t o a great extent t h e number o f f a c t i o n s .

In Hitchcock's K h a l i p u r study a single i n d i v i d u a l managed

t o assume most o f t h e r e i n s o f power and f a c t i o n s virtually

ceased t o e x i s t a s l o n g a s he r e m a i n e d i n control. H i s down-

fall a f t e r ten years i n 'office' came p a r t i a l l y as t h e r e s u l t

o f h i s own f a i l i n g s , but p a r t i a l l y because there came on t o

the s c e n e o t h e r y o u n g e r i n d i v i d u a l s who w e r e a b l e and ambitious.

With t h e i r coming and t h e p r e v i o u s leader's passing, factions

within the dominant Rajput caste rose a g a i n , each headed by

one of the able and a m b i t i o u s y o u n g e r men. Since the p o l i t i -

c a l p i e does n o t g e t l a r g e r i n the v i l l a g e except i n the long

run, each o f these i n d i v i d u a l s i s competing f o r a static

amount o f power. One I n d i v i d u a l c a n g a i n more p o w e r o n l y a t

the expense o f another Individual. Each I n d i v i d u a l attempts

to a l i g n a s many o f h i s f e l l o w c a s t e members w i t h h i s p o s i -

tion as p o s s i b l e . The more h o u s e h o l d s t h e r e are t o back him the

stronger i s h i s p o l i t i c a l position r e l a t i v e to other positions.

Too many a b l e and a m b i t i o u s i n d i v i d u a l s might tear a village

apart—particularly i f they make t o o much u s e o f t h e i n t e r c a s t e


89

group f o r which they are the jajman. Pear of l o s i n g control

of the lower castes probably limits this kind of competition--

at any r a t e , I have s e e n nowhere i n t h e l i t e r a t u r e any e x a m p l e s

of a s t r u g g l e between f a c t i o n s which has l e d t o t h e d o w n f a l l

of t h e dominant caste. J u s t a s t o o many p r o m i n e n t individuals

could cause problems f o r the dominant caste so the l a c k o f

prominent l e a d e r s may cause problems. This would particularly

be the case should t h e r e be a b l e and a m b i t i o u s leaders among

the lower castes.

Cohesiveness of the f a c t i o n i s at l e a s t as i m p o r t a n t as

size i f n o t more s o a n d c o h e s i v e n e s s i s directly related to

the p e r s o n a l i t y of the leader. The f a c t i o n w i l l operate

successfully i n the face of other f a c t i o n s only as l o n g as

the leader i s able to maintain unity.

LENGTH OP R E S I D E N C E I N THE VILLAGE

Length of residence i n the v i l l a g e , f o r purposes of

demarcating factions, i s measured i n terms o f depth of lineage.

The effective historical p e r i o d i n terms o f f a c t i o n formation

is. only as f a r b a c k as l i n e a g e s c a n be t r a c e d . I n any given

village there w i l l be c e r t a i n lineages which c a n be t r a c e d

f u r t h e r back than others. Often the oldest lineage i s d i r e c t l y

descended from the v i l l a g e founder or at least i s thought t o

be directly descended. This lineage w i l l feel a certain amount

of u n i t y i n the face of other l i n e a g e s and i n c e r t a i n types of

i s s u e s may operate as a f a c t i o n t o oppose o t h e r lineages. This


90

lineage may o r may not be powerful: the vigourousness of

the lineage ( i . e . the presence of dynamic and interested

leaders and f o l l o w e r s ) i s as important as i t s depth.

Thus a v e r y o l d l i n e a g e may be dying out and even

though i t continues to act as a u n i t i t s power w i l l not

be as great as a n o t h e r , newer l i n e a g e which is vigourous

about i t s interests.

The formation of f a c t i o n s on the basis of lineage may

be the r e s u l t of an o l d q u a r r e l or through the process of

fission. The f u r t h e r back a l i n e a g e can trace i t s origin the

greater the distance there will be between the living members

of the lineage. T h e r e seems t o be a limit not only to the

number o f h o u s e h o l d s w h i c h can cooperate, but as well a limit

in terms of d i s t a n c e of k i n s h i p t i e s . Brothers are usually

found w i t h i n the same f a c t i o n . First cousins may be included

d e p e n d i n g upon the i s s u e , but beyond fairly close kinship ties

it is difficult to maintain cooperation. A l t h o u g h most fac-

tions c o n t a i n households which are related fairly closely,

some f a c t i o n s a r e formed where t h e r e are no kinship t i e s —

the basis for cooperation in this kind of f a c t i o n i s a similar

attitude toward a p a r t i c u l a r issue and may not last beyond the

successful or u n s u c c e s s f u l r e s o l u t i o n of the issue.

Aside from being one of the founding lineages there are

at l e a s t two other ways i n w h i c h a new lineage may become

established i n the village and become t h e basis f o r new fac-

tions . The first way i s that an i n d i v i d u a l may come i n t o the

village s o m e t i m e a f t e r i t i s f o u n d e d and establish a household


91

f r o m w h i c h a new l i n e a g e springs. Because the caste i s

endogamous t h e two l i n e a g e s are ultimately related, but i t

may n o t b e p o s s i b l e to trace the linkage. The v a l i d i t y o f t h e

newcomer's c l a i m to a particular caste status w i l l be Investi-

gated before he i s a l l o w e d t o become a member o f t h e v i l l a g e ,

but such tenuous connections a r e n o t o f much i m p o r t a n c e t o

faction formation within the v i l l a g e . The I n c o m i n g founder

h o u s e h o l d may h a v e m e r e l y b o u g h t land i n the v i l l a g e 0 10


the

individual may h a v e come a s a s u p p l i c a n t seeking refuge from

some k i n d o f awkward s i t u a t i o n i n the v i l l a g e of o r i g i n . The

individual may h a v e come a s a p a r t i a l o r c o m p l e t e conqueror.

The Jati caste i n R a m p u r may h a v e e n t e r e d the v i l l a g e i n this

way. A t any r a t e this m i g h t be an e x p l a n a t i o n f o r the fact

that the J a t i s I n t h e Rampur a r e o f much l o w e r c a s t e status

than the other land-owning castes i n that part of north India.

The Jatis may p e r h a p s h a v e b e e n g r a n t e d land i n return f o r

helping some m i l i t a r y c o n q u e r o r who h a d moved i n t o the area

some h u n d r e d s o f y e a r s ago.

The s e c o n d way I n w h i c h a new l i n e a g e c a n come t o be

established w i t h i n the v i l l a g e I s f o r an i n d i v i d u a l who i s

related t o an e s t a b l i s h e d lineage through female t i e s t o take

up land i n the v i l l a g e either by p u r c h a s e o r t h r o u g h g i f t . An

example o f t h i s m i g h t be t h e m a r r i a g e o f a y o u n g man i n t o a

household which has nothing but females i n the younger genera-

tion. This kind of beginning Is not considered very auspicious

and i t may t a k e a l i n e a g e established i n this way q u i t e a number


92

of generations t o be c o n s i d e r e d by o t h e r lineages i n the

caste as l e g i t i m a t e . The m a n n e r i n w h i c h t h e l i n e a g e comes

Into e x i s t e n c e has a great d e a l t o do w i t h the p r e s t i g e of

the f a c t i o n which i s formed out of the l i n e a g e .

Even where t h e e n t i r e caste population i n the v i l l a g e i s

closely related and where t h e r e has n o t been any In-migratlon

one can expect f a c t i o n s t o develop because the very size of

the g r o u p makes i t t o o u n w i e l d y - - u n l e s s there is a single

strong leader or a very strong reason f o rmaintaining unity

of caste w i t h i n the v i l l a g e .

THE TYPE OP I S S U E

The i s s u e which i s under c o n s i d e r a t i o n w i t h i n the caste

p o p u l a t i o n has a great significance f o r the formation of

factions. Issues develop at three different levels within

the village. The i s s u e s a t t h e f i r s t level concern those

events which e f f e c t just the caste Itself. Factions are

formed and m a i n t a i n e d as t h e r e s u l t o f , f o r example, a

court case over irrigation rights or over a boundary dispute

or again over certain forms o f caste b e h a v i o u r relating to

ritual purity. The f a c t i o n lines harden over the years and

further e x a m p l e s a r e f o u n d by e a c h o f t h e f a c t i o n s w h i c h show

that they need t o m a i n t a i n unity.

Issues which Involve other castes tend to create unity

between f a c t i o n s t h a t otherwise m i g h t be b i t t e r enemies. If

the Chamar c a s t e suddenly decides t o g i v e up i t s t r a d i t i o n a l

occupation o f l e a t h e r w o r k e r a n d become more sanskrltlzed


93

(cf. p. ) this will effect a l l o f t h e members o f t h e d o m i -

nant caste equally. I n many v i l l a g e s i n north India the

C h a m a r s may i n c l u d e a s much a s a q u a r t e r of the v i l l a g e popu-

lation and t h e i r attempt at s a n s k r i t i z a t i o n would represent

a full scale threat of revolution. T h e r e c a n be l i t t l e ques-

tion of disagreement among h o u s e h o l d s of t h e dominant caste

if they are t o preserve their hold i n the village. In effect

a committee o f t h e whole w i l l be f o r m e d b y t h e d o m i n a n t caste

to deal with the matter.

Issues at the third level are those i n which the world

outside the v i l l a g e becomes t h e f o c u s . The v i l l a g e caste

population w i l l normally t r y t o present a united front to

outsiders from other nearby v i l l a g e s even though they be o f

the same c a s t e . This does n o t always h o l d t r u e how ever.


T
One

f a c t i o n may t r y t o e x p l o i t i t s relationships with individuals

or groups outside of the village i n order t o improve their

position relative t o other f a c t i o n s I n the caste. Pactions

may even develop i n response t o the attempt o f one g r o u p o f

h o u s e h o l d s t o g a i n power w i t h i n t h e v i l l a g e by t a k i n g advantage

of r e l a t i o n s h i p s formed w i t h powerful individuals outside the

village.

FACTIONS WITHIN NONLAND-OWNING CASTES

Factions exist, o r can e x i s t , i n any o f t h e c a s t e s

resident i n the village. I n Rampur, f o r e x a m p l e , b o t h t h e


6

Chamars a n d t h e B h a n g i s a r e d i v i d e d i n t o factions. That

other castes are not divided i s a function of size. A caste


94

which has o n l y three or four households i s not very likely to

be divided. Since there is little intercaste sociability i f

the three or four households are not united there is a great

need t o get a l o n g w i t h one a n o t h e r . They n e e d e a c h o t h e r t o o

much e c o n o m i c a l l y and s o c i a l l y to quarrel.

The fact t h a t I t I s p o s s i b l e t o d i s c o v e r f a c t i o n s among

castes other than the dominant land-owning caste does n o t

mean t h a t t h e r e is political activity among c a s t e s other than

the dominant caste. I n terms o f my definition of p o l i t i c a l

activity, factional activity among t h e C h a m a r s a n d B h a n g i s


7

is not p o l i t i c a l . The Chamar f a c t i o n s I n Rampur are based

on t h e p o s i t i o n s e a c h o f two g r o u p s o f h o u s e h o l d s took with

respect t o the 'kidnapping'of aChamar g i r l by a group o f

Chamars f r o m a n o t h e r village. The g i r l who was kidnapped

became t h e w i f e o f one o f t h e o u t s i d e r C h a r n a r s — t h i s was

why s h e was k i d n a p p e d i n t h e f i r s t place. The B h a n g i factions'

a r e b a s e d on a q u a r r e l o v e r who was t o r e p l a c e a dead headman

of the caste. Some h o u s e h o l d s favoured one i n d i v i d u a l and

another group o f households favoured another I n d i v i d u a l each

o f whom a p p e a r e d t o h a v e a b a s i s f o r m a k i n g t h e c l a i m t h a t he

should be t h e n e x t headman.

In n e i t h e r of these cases i s there any chance o f g a i n i n g

control over land. N e i t h e r o f t h e i s s u e s have a n y t h i n g t o do

with acquisition or maintenance of land ownership.


95

S A N S K R I T I Z A T I O N AS A LCNG TERM P O L I T I C A L ACTIVITY

The first u s e o f t h e t e r m S a n s k r i t i z a t i o n was made b y

Srinivas i n a 1952 s t u d y of the r e l i g i o u s and s o c i a l life

of t h e Coorgs o f South I n d i a . Srinivas explained t h e term

in a f o l l o w i n g passage:

The c a s t e s y s t e m I s f a r f r o m a r i g i d s y s t e m i n
w h i c h t h e p o s i t i o n o f each component c a s t e i s
f i x e d f o ra l l time. Movement h a s a l w a y s b e e n
p o s s i b l e , and e s p e c i a l l y so I n t h e m i d d l e r e g i o n s
of the h i e r a r c h y . A l o w c a s t e was a b l e , i n a
generation o r two, t o r i s e t o a higher p o s i t i o n
i n t h e h i e r a r c h y by a d o p t i n g v e g e t a r i a n i s m and
t e e t o t a l i s m , and by S a n s k r i t i z i n g I t s r i t u a l and
pantheon. I n s h o r t , i t t o o k o v e r , as f a r as
p o s s i b l e , t h e customs, r i t e s , and b e l i e f s o f t h e
B r a h m i n s , a n d t h e a d o p t i o n o f t h e B r a h m i n i c way
o f l i f e b y a l o w c a s t e w h i c h seems t o h a v e b e e n
f r e q u e n t , though t h e o r e t i c a l l y f o r b i d d e n . The
process has been c a l l e d " S a n s k r i t i z a t i o n " i n t h i s
b o o k , i n p r e f e r e n c e t o " B r a h m l n i z a t i o n , " as c e r -
t a i n Vedic r i t e s a r e c o n f i n e d t o t h e Brahmins and
t h e two o t h e r " t w i c e - b o r n " castes.9

The term 'sanskritization' was p u t f o r w a r d to explain certain

kinds of behaviour patterns which function to increase the

power o f p a r t i c u l a r castes i n the v i l l a g e relative to the

other castes. I t i s a u s e f u l term because i t d i f f e r e n t i a t e s

between two t y p e s o f power p l a y s . Sanskritization refers to

behaviour on t h e p a r t o f t h e caste which I s d i r e c t e d not

towards changing the s t r u c t u r e o f the v i l l a g e , but rather i s

directed toward changing t h e s t a t u s quo. In other words,

s a n s k r i t i z i n g behaviour i s essentially conservative I n nature.

The second type o f p o w e r p l a y w h i c h i s known a s W e s t e r n i z a t i o n

is d i r e c t e d toward overthrowing t h e whole s t r u c t u r e . Both o f

these f o r c e s a r e a t work I n t h e v i l l a g e . Sanskritization as a


96

process has b e e n o p e r a t i n g f o r h u n d r e d s , and perhaps thousands

of years. Westernization as a process o n l y began t o operate

after the arrival of the British.

Since the 1952 study q u o t e d above, S r i n i v a s has somewhat

modified his definition. S r i n i v a s had assumed t h a t t h e model

the lower c l a s s e s w o u l d be emulating was the Brahminical

model. Pocock p o i n t e d out i n a 1955 publication 1 0


that the

K s h a t r i y a m o d e l was u s e d i n some r e g i o n s of I n d i a :

J u s t as t h e K s h a t r i y a o r K i n g s t a n d s w i t h t h e B r a h m i n
as s u p e r i o r t o t h e V a i s h y a a n d S h u d r a v a r n a , so we
may a l s o s p e a k o f t h e K i n g l y m o d e l i n H i n d u s o c i e t y w h i c h
Is complementary t o , though dependent i n c e r t a i n r e s p e c t s
upon, the Brahmlnic. A t any g i v e n t i m e o r p l a c e t h e
K i n g l y m o d e l i s r e p r e s e n t e d by t h e d o m i n a n t p o l i t i c a l
p o w e r i n a n y a r e a , a n d i s m e d i a t e d by t h e l o c a l d o m i -
nant non-Brahmin caste or castes of that area. Thus
i n s e c u l a r m a t t e r s t h e M o g h u l s and t h e B r i t i s h a t
v a r i o u s t i m e s h a v e p r o v i d e d a s t a n d a r d by w h i c h s e c u -
l a r p r e s t i g e I s gauged.

S a n s k r i t i z a t i o n has come t o s t a n d f o r the process whereby the

lower castes in a particular area w i l l emulate the behaviour

of the dominant land-owning caste whether that caste traces

its origins t o any of the varna. I n terms o f t h i s discussion

what i s i m p o r t a n t i s the effort t h a t a c a s t e makes towards

sanskritizing i t s behaviour patterns. Success In the venture

depends upon s e v e r a l t h i n g s . I f the caste attempts t o make

too great a change i t w i l l likely be sanctioned by the castes

above i t . Chamars, f o r example, are at the very bottom of the

c a s t e h i e r a r c h y and would have l i t t l e luck In attempting to

model t h e i r behaviour on t h a t of the Brahmins In the village.

They w o u l d n o r m a l l y emulate the behaviour of a caste only a


97

few ranks above them. A l o n g w i t h the change i n b e h a v i o u r there

m u s t be some c h a n g e i n t h e e c o n o m i c s t a t u s of the group. They

m u s t somehow f i n d a source o f income which would place them

higher than they had been p r e v i o u s l y relative t o the other

castes. Finally, the success o f the attempt depends upon t h e

strength and u n i t y of the upper castes. I f the upper castes

are s p l i t i n their attitudes towards this attempt a t upward

mobility i twill be much e a s i e r f o r the attempt to succeed.

SOURCES OF POWER WITHIN THE VILLAGE

So f a r i n t h i s c h a p t e r I have c a r e f u l l y refrained from

u s i n g t h e word power. I have d i s c u s s e d those activities which

are p o l i t i c a l . These a c t i v i t i e s are pursued by households,

factions, and c a s t e i n t h e hope t h a t s h o u l d t h e y be successful

they w i l l have g a i n e d power r e l a t i v e to other households,

factions and c a s t e s . Power a c c r u e s to households, factions,

or caste from several different sources of which successful

political activity I s b u t one. The e c o n o m i c a c t i v i t i e s dis-

cussed i n the l a s t chapter are a second source. A third source

o f p o w e r comes f r o m t h e p o s i t i o n h e l d i n t h e r i t u a l hierarchy.

A fourth source comes f r o m t h e i n d i v i d u a l s involved. A dynamic,

ambitious individual will h a v e m o r e p o w e r t h a n one who i s not

all else equal.

As i n m o s t s o c i a l systems there i s a definite positive

c o r r e l a t i o n b e t w e e n p o w e r h o l d e r s i n one k i n d of a c t i v i t y and

power h o l d e r s i n t h e o t h e r k i n d s o f activity.
98

The principle of 'circular and c u m u l a t i v e causation'

as developed by M y r d a l 1 1
among o t h e r s , i s q u i t e appropriate

in the v i l l a g e setting. A single household w i l l only rarely

enjoy p o w e r i n one a r e a of a c t i v i t y without having power i n

other activities. This d o e s n o t mean t h a t a particular house-

hold w i l l occupy r o u g h l y t h e same p o s i t i o n i n a l l of the

various p o w e r - s o u r c e h i e r a r c h i e s , r a t h e r i t means t h a t a

p a r t i c u l a r household high i n one h i e r a r c h y w i l l , o r c a n , be

high i n another hierarchy without any a p p a r e n t b a s i s . Thus

a very poor Brahmin household w i l l likely h a v e some political

power because i t i s at the top of the r i t u a l h i e r a r c h y , and

conversely a wealthy, low caste household (a not very likely

occurrence) will h a v e some p o l i t i c a l power. Normally, how-

ever, there i s little of this kind of t h i n g happening i n the

village. Should a low caste group g a i n w e a l t h they will

gradually rise on t h e r i t u a l hierarchy relative to other

castes. I t i s t o o d i s t u r b i n g t o have these kinds of dis-

parities i n the v i l l a g e .

Before ending this chapter I should like to discuss the

p a n c h a y a t , t h e d e s c r i p t i o n and workings o f which are u s u a l l y

included i n chapters on p o l i t i c s of Indian v i l l a g e s . The

assumption i s that the panchayat i s the focus of factional

disputes—that I s , t h a t one c a n o b s e r v e t h e d e l i n e a t i o n a n d

interaction of f a c t i o n s best at panchayat meetings. I agree

in t h e main w i t h t h i s assumption. I t I s during meetings of


99

the panchayat t h a t the f a c t i o n lines a r e most c l e a r l y formed.

H o w e v e r , much o f t h e b u s i n e s s of the panchayat i s not really

political a c c o r d i n g t o my definition of p o l i t i c a l . Pactional

disputes need not always center around control over land-

indeed many d i s p u t e s a r i s e as t h e r e s u l t o f w h a t one faction

considers d e v i a n t b e h a v i o u r on t h e p a r t o f a member o f another

faction. A l t h o u g h I have n e v e r s e e n any statistics, i t i s my

impression from r e a d i n g the l i t e r a t u r e that the bulk of the

disputes which are s e t t l e d (or I f not settled, at l e a s t brought

into the perview of the panchayat) are n o n p o l i t i c a l i n nature.

I would hypothesize t h a t most o f t h e f a c t i o n a l interaction

whose s u b j e c t I s c o n t r o l over land takes place outside of the

panchayat. Only on the r a r e occasions when t h e r e is a con-

c r e t e p o i n t t o argue i s the panchayat used. For example, two

households may be d i s p u t i n g a boundary and the f a c t i o n s backing

each of the households may meet i n a p a n c h a y a t to settle the

differences. Most p o l i t i c a l activity i s o f a more s u b t l e

nature and, again h y p o t h e s i z i n g , r e v o l v e s around such things

as a t t e m p t i n g to persuade households to r e a l i g n themselves

with another faction.

SUMMARY

In d i s c u s s i n g p o l i t i c a l activity at the v i l l a g e level i t

Is possible to either see a l l a c t i v i t y as p o l i t i c a l or to see

very little activity as p o l i t i c a l . I have chosen the latter

because I t makes i t e a s i e r t o d e c i d e how to a t t a c k the problem


100

of inducing change a t t h e v i l l a g e level. A l la c t i v i t i e s have

s o m e t h i n g about them t h a t i s p o l i t i c a l and, a g a i n , a l l activi-

ties have s o m e t h i n g about them t h a t i s economic or r e l i g i o u s .

However, I think i t c a n be s a i d of every activity i n the

village that i t i s predominantly one o r t h e o t h e r of the

possibilities. The v a l u e of this approach w i l l become more

evident i n t h e f o l l o w i n g and l a s t chapter.


101

FOOTNOTES
1
a) P. G. B a i l e y , T r i b e , C a s t e a n d N a t i o n - A S t u d y
of P o l i t i c a l A c t i v i t y and P o l i t i c a l Change i n
H i g h l a n d Q r i s s a ( M a n c h e s t e r ^ I960).

b) D h i l l o n , L e a d e r s h i p and Groups - a South I n d i a


V i l l a g e , New D e l h i P l a n n i n g C o m m i s s i o n , P r o g r a m
E v a l u a t i o n O r g . , G o v t , o f I n d i a , 1955.

c) J . T. H i t c h c o c k , " L e a d e r s h i p - a N o r t h I n d i a n
Village: Two C a s e S t u d i e s , " L e a d e r s h i p a n d P o l i t i -
c a l I n s t i t u t i o n s - I n d i a , e d . R. L . P a r k a n d
I . T i n k e r TPrTnceton, 1959).

d) Oscar Lewis, V i l l a g e L i f e - Northern Indi? .New York,


1958), e s p e c i a l l y C h a p t e r 4.

Other articles Include:


a) F. G. B a i l e y , " P o l i t i c s - Village India," an
unpublished a r t i c l e .

b) P. G. B a i l e y , " D e c i s i o n s b y C o n s e n s u s - C o u n c i l s
and Committees: with S p e c i a l Reference t o V i l l a g e
and L o c a l Government - I n d i a , " P o l i t i c a l Systems
a n d t h e D i s t r i b u t i o n o f P o w e r , ASA M o n o g r a p h (New
Yoi k7 1965) •
T _

c) R. W. N i c h o l a s , " P a c t i o n s : A Comparative A n a l y s i s , "


P o l i t i c a l Systems and t h e D i s t r i b u t i o n o f Power,
ASA M o n o g r a p h (New Y o r k , 196FuH
2
Lewis, op_. c i t . , p. 115-
E d w a r d E . L e C l a i r , J r . , "The D y n a m i c s o f t h e P a n c h a y a t
S y s t e m o f M o d e r n I n d i a , " C o n t e m p o r a r y I n d i a , e d . B. N. V a r n a
(New Y o r k , 1 9 6 4 ) , p p . 206-17-
4H i t c h c o c k , op_. c i t . , C h a p t e r 7 •
5
The p o l i t i c a l p i e i s c o n t r o l o v e r l a n d u n t i l s u c h t i m e
as t h e v i l l a g e b e c o m e s more c o n s c i o u s l y a n i n t e g r a l p a r t o f
the l a r g e r w o r l d o u t s i d e t h e v i l l a g e .
6
L e w i s , op_. c i t . , p . 137-
l b i d . , p . 138 .
7

8
lbld., p . 139-
9
"M. N. S r i n i v a s , R e l i g i o n a n d S o c i e t y among t h e C o o r g s
of S o u t h I n d i a ( O x f o r d , 1952), p . 32.
102

1 0
D. P. P o c o c k , "The Movement of Castes," Man, May, 1955,
pp. 71-72.

P o w e r i s d e f i n e d as t h e a b i l i t y
i : L
t o i n f l u e n c e the atti-
t u d e s and a c t i o n s o f o t h e r s .

Gunnar M y r d a l , Rich Lands and Poor (New Y o r k , 1957),


p. 11-12.
L H A P T E R VI

Panchayat! R a j 1

In t h e p r e v i o u s c h a p t e r s I have o u t l i n e d the social

structure of the v i l l a g e i n order that I can p o i n t out the

way i n w h i c h t h e s e s t r u c t u r e s h a v e b e e n c h a n g e d and a r e

being changed by t h e i n t r o d u c t i o n o f a new c o n c e p t o f t h e

nature o f the panchayat. Panchayats are e v i d e n t l y as o l d as

India. It i s difficult t o know how l o n g t h e y h a v e t e e n part

of the village social s t r u c t u r e , b u t i t appears that the con-


2

c e p t was a l r e a d y extant during Vedic times. The t e r m pan-

chayat literally means c o u n c i l of five, but I n actual usage

the term r e f e r s t o an a p p r o a c h t o d e c i s i o n making rather

than t o a p a r t i c u l a r body o f I n d i v i d u a l s . Most simply the

panchayat i s a body b r o u g h t t o g e t h e r I n order t o conduct

deliberations about m a t t e r s o f importance t o t h e v i l l a g e o r

to the caste I f I t i s a caste panchayat. Traditionally i t

is n o t an o f f i c i a l body, I t h a s no o f f i c i a l members, no

official m e e t i n g t i m e , and no o f f i c i a l matters t o which i t

must a t t e n d . When p r o b l e m s i n s o l u b l e b y o t h e r means arise

in the v i l l a g e It i s likely that a panchayat w i l l be convened.

If i t i s a matter which c a n be t a k e n c a r e o f a t t h e c a s t e level

a caste panchayat will meet. I f , f o r example, two h o u s e h o l d s

within t h e c a s t e h a v e some k i n d o f argument t h a t Is threatening

the unity of the caste, a caste panchayat w i l l meet. The

panchayat would include t h e heads o f t h e two h o u s e h o l d s and

103
10 4

discussion would continue u n t i l a consensus i s reached.

Everyone m u s t be i n agreement. Voting and m a j o r i t y deci-

sions were d e f i n i t e l y not part of the concept of the pan-

chayat. Should a dispute arise between households of dif-

ferent castes then a panchayat of a m u l t i c a s t e nature would

be assembled to discuss and deliberate the i s s u e . The vast

bulk of the ' c a s e s ' h a n d l e d by p a n c h a y a t s were nonpolitical

in nature--that i s , disputes arising out of c o n f l i c t over

land c o n t r o l were few r e l a t i v e to other kinds of disputes.

The effectiveness of the panchayat Is related t o the

willingness o f t h e two sides to modify their position.

Without this m o d i f i c a t i o n through which t h e two sides reach

a middle ground, t h e r e c a n be no d e c i s i o n . In ancient times,

as i n t h e p r e s e n t , i t c a n be fatal to the u n i t y of the village

when c o n s e n s u s c a n n o t be reached about a c r u c i a l matter. If

It i s known b e f o r e h a n d t h a t consensus will n o t be reached

the panchayat may not convene. An attempt i s made t o I g n o r e

the problem.

The willingness to modify a position i s determined by

the interaction o f two factors. The first factor i s the amount

of s u p p o r t t h e i n d i v i d u a l h o u s e h o l d c a n g e n e r a t e among o t h e r

households. The stronger the support the l e s s likelihood

there I s f o r any modification. The second f a c t o r tends to

counteract the f i r s t . The second f a c t o r has t o do w i t h the

extent to which the household i s t i e d t o the v i l l a g e . Most

households are c l o s e l y tied to the v i l l a g e economically i f


105

not socially and r e l i g i o u s l y . Unwillingness t o modify a

position means t h a t e i t h e r one o r t h e o t h e r of the parties

m i g h t be f o r c e d t o l e a v e the v i l l a g e or that the v i l l a g e

m i g h t be s p l i t i n two. Neither of these possibilities Is

very d e s i r a b l e f o r t h e same r e a s o n s w h i c h I explained In

chapter four. Thus most p o s i t i o n s a r e m o d i f i e d before total

chaos results.

In reality the village p a n c h a y a t i s a l s o t h e cas~ :e !

panchayat o f t h e dominant caste i n the v i l l a g e so t h a t while

we c a n n o t c o m p l e t e l y ignore caste panchayats i t i s the v i l l a g e

panchayat which i s important f o rthis discussion. The members

of the v i l l a g e panchayat would normally b e made up o f t h e

powerful heads o f t h e households o f t h e dominant c a s t e plus

the head o f t h e dominant household o f each o f t h e o t h e r castes

in the v i l l a g e . T h e s e l a t t e r a t t e n d more b y i n v i t a t i o n than

by right and w o u l d n o t be p r e s e n t at a l l panchayats—they

w o u l d be p r e s e n t only at those i n which discussions directly

affecting their own c a s t e are undertaken. Membership i s , t h e n ,

almost e n t i r e l y ascriptive. Membership i s o n l y achieved on

rare occasions.

T h i s was t h e t y p e of l o c a l government i n o p e r a t i o n when

the B r i t i s h moved i n t o the subcontinent. I t i s so i n f o r m a l

that the B r i t i s h probably d i d n o t even r e c o g n i z e i t . A l l they

could s e e was a d o m i n a n t c a s t e telling the rest of the castes

what t o do.
106

It is difficult t } really know t h e thinking behind the

British decision to reconstitute the v i l l a g e panchayats in

a form more f a m i l i a r to the B r i t i s h but one must assume i t

was because they felt the whole v i l l a g e should share i n the

decision-making process and b e c a u s e t h e new form would result

In more d e c i s i v e action taken i n a shorter time. That they

were committed to i n d i r e c t rule i s beyond doubt. Not only

were they p h i l o s o p h i c a l l y a g a i n s t complete direct cortrol,

but they were not numerous enough t o e n f o r c e i t .

The British response t o the t w i n needs o f i n d i r e c t rule

and more d e c i s i v e action on t h e p a r t o f v i l l a g e councils was

to pass l e g i s l a t i o n which would ensure that every village have

a democratically elected official panchayat w i t h which they,

the B r i t i s h , could deal i n times of need. The need, at least

in early British t i m e s , was mainly concerned w i t h the efficient

collection of revenue from each village.

The British attempt t o change t h e c h a r a c t e r o f t h e pan-

chayat was largely u n s u c c e s s f u l f o r the same r e a s o n that the

older, i n f o r m a l panchayat was largely successful. Individuals

really had very little choice. The village r e s i d e n t s would be

hard put to s u r v i v e unless they cooperated. L i f e was hard

enough w i t h o u t h a v i n g t o c o n t e n d w i t h enemies i n s i d e the

village. M o r e i m p o r t a n t l y , t h e d o m i n a n t c a s t e was very domi-

nant indeed. Their control over the r e s t of the v i l l a g e popula-

tion was virtually complete. The only alternative to doing

what t h e d o m i n a n t caste suggested was to leave the v i l l a g e and


107

join c a s t e mates i n a n o t h e r village. A n d one w o u l d still be

at t h e mercy of t h e dominant caste i n that v i l l a g e . For a

member o f t h e d o m i n a n t caste the decision to fight fora

particular s i d e i n an argument w i t h no i n t e n t i o n to give i n

w o u l d be e q u a l l y d a n g e r o u s f o rthe r e s t of the caste would

merely o s t r a c i z e h i m a n d q u i c k l y he w o u l d lose h i s position

in the v i l l a g e . J u s t as m i g r a t i n g t o a new v i l l a g e was a

possibility f o rthe lower castes so t h e upper c a s t e household

could entertain this possibility. To do s o w o u l d mean start-

ing a l l over because t h e upper castes i n t h e new v i l l a g e would

not likely sell o r g i v e l a n d t o t h e newcomer.

U n d e r t h e new B r i t i s h l e g i s l a t i o n any h o u s e h o l d head

c o u l d be e l e c t e d t o t h e p a n c h a y a t . In p r a c t i c e the household

heads o f the lower castes could not run f o r office because

their e c o n o m i c w e l l - b e i n g was c o n t r o l l e d by t h e dominant

caste. They v o t e d as they were t o l d . The o f f i c i a l panchayat

nearly always looked exactly like the u n o f f i c i a l panchayat.

The m e m b e r s h i p was a l m o s t certainly t h e same. Occasionally

a group o f t h e lower castes might get together and e l e c t one

of themselves t o the panchayat. The e f f e c t that this lone

individual c o u l d h a v e o n t h e r e s t o f t h e members was negligible

and would normally only serve to increase h o s t i l i t y between

the c a s t e s which worked a g a i n s t the v i l l a g e i n the long run.

Sometimes t h e dominant c a s t e a l l o w e d the lower castes to elect

a member f r o m among t h e m s e l v e s , but t h i s individual w o u l d be

so concerned about a v o i d i n g c o n f l i c t and g e t t i n g a l o n g with


108

the other p a n c h a y a t members t h a t , a g a i n , he c o u l d have little

effect on t h e d e c i s i o n s of the panchayat.

The British attempt t o c l a r i f y the decision-making

machinery w i t h i n the v i l l a g e was p r e t t y much a f a i l u r e . The

British d i d n o t make j u s t one a t t e m p t , h o w e v e r , r a t h e r one

could s a y t h e y n e v e r g a v e up i n a t t e m p t i n g t o change t h e

decision-making process. Throughout their long administration

of the subcontinent they continued t o push t h e i d e a \.f t h e

elected panchayat. Meanwhile other f a c t o r s o f change were a t

w o r k on t h e s u b c o n t i n e n t . A i l of these f a c t o r s , w h i c h seem t o

operate everywhere I n the world, combined t o decrease t h e

insularity of the v i l l a g e . Increasingly the outside world

i m p i n g e d upon l i f e i n the v i l l a g e . The i n f o r m a l , flexible

style of dealing with problems s t i l l worked t o a l a r g e extent,

but i n s o l u b l e problems i n c r e a s i n g l y plagued the v i l l a g e .

When t h e B r i t i s h pulled out o f I n d i a i n 19^7 they left

a t r a d i t i o n behind them. One f a c e t of this t r a d i t i o n was a n

e m p h a s i s on t h e e l e c t e d v i l l a g e panchayat. The n a t i o n a l

leaders of India continued the B r i t i s h tradition--unavoidable

considering that nearly a l l of the Indian leaders were British

educated either i n Britain itself, or i n Indian schools closely

patterned after British schools.

The Indian n a t i o n a l government passed legislation soon

after independence which o u t l i n e d the broad p a t t e r n of the

panchayat! r a j . As e a r l y a s 19^8 Nehru d e c l a r e d at the f i r s t

Local Self-Government M i n i s t e r s ' Conference that "Democracy


109

at t h e t o p c o u l d n o t he a s u c c e s s u n l e s s i ti s built on t h e

f o u n d a t i o n from below." J
The n a t i o n a l g o v e r n m e n t s e t out the

broad outlines of the panchayat! r a j , but l e f t implementation

up to the states out of r e c o g n i t i o n that the d i f f e r e n t culture

areas would require different handling of the matter. The

recommendations of a nationally a p p o i n t e d S t u d y Team o n t h i s

m a t t e r were a d o p t e d . T h e i r recommendations follow:

F i r s t l y , we s h o u l d h a v e v i l l a g e p a n c h a y a t s p u r e l y
on a n e l e c t i v e b a s i s , w i t h a p r o v i s i o n f o r t h e c o -
o p t i o n o f t w o women members a n d one member e a c h
f r o m t h e s c h e d u l e d c a s t e s and s c h e d u l e d t r i b e s .
S e c o n d l y , P a n c h a y a t S a m i t i s h o u l d be f o r m e d f o r
an a r e a i n c l u d e d i n a b l o c k a t p r e s e n t t o be c o n -
s t i t u t e d by i n d i r e c t e l e c t i o n f r o m t h e v i l l a g e
panchayats. The p a n c h a y a t s w i t h i n t h e b l o c k a r e a
c a n be g r o u p e d t o g e t h e r i n c o n v e n i e n t u n i t s a n d t h e
panches of a l l t h e panchayats i n each o f t h e s e u n i t s
s h a l l e l e c t f r o m amongst t h e m s e l v e s p e r s o n o r p e r -
s o n s t o b e members o f P a n c h a y a t S a m i t i , a b o u t 20 i n
number. . . .Vast powers have been e n t r u s t e d t o t h i s
body w h i c h s h o u l d be t h e m a i n a g e n c y f o r d e v e l o p m e n t
work i n t h a t a r e a w i t h s u f f i c i e n t r e s o u r c e s , b o t h
C e n t r a l as w e l l as P r o v i n c i a l , a t i t s d i s p o s a l .
Then t h e r e w o u l d be t h e Z i l a P a r i s h a d a t t h e D i s t r i c t
l e v e l , mainly w i t h a view t o enable the necessary co-
o r d i n a t i o n b e t w e e n t h e P a n c h a y a t S a m i t i , a l l members
o f t h e S t a t e L e g i s l a t u r e a n d o f P a r l i a m e n t whose
c o n s t i t u e n c i e s l i e w i t h i n t h e d i s t r i c t and t h e d i s -
trict level officers.^

The village p a n c h a y a t , t h e n , i s t h e broad base on w h i c h t h e

rest o f t h e government superstructure i s to rest. Gandhi

wrote of panchayats i n t h e f o l l o w i n g manner, " I n d i a n inde-

pendence must b e g i n a t t h e b o t t o m . Every v i l l a g e s h o u l d be

a republic or a panchayat having f u l l powers—the greater

t h e power o f p a n c h a y a t s the better f o r the people."5 Thus

each v i l l a g e i s t o have an e l e c t e d panchayat some o f w h o s e


110

6
members w i l l be p l a c e d on t h e b l o c k level panchayat which is

intermediate to the d i s t r i c t level Zila Parlshad.

Implementation of panchayat! r a j by the s t a t e s began i n


r 7

1959 and had been c a r r i e d out almost c o m p l e t e l y by 1902. The

panchayats which came i n t o existence during these years are

quite different than e i t h e r the t r a d i t i o n a l village panchayat

or the B r i t i s h n o t i o n of the v i l l a g e panchayat. In the first

place, the I n d i a n n o t i o n i s a r a t h e r s t r a n g e one, perhaps I

should say a d i v i d e d one. The state and national governments

recognize the v i l l a g e as an autonomous s o c i a l unit. For

example, i t i s the I n d i a n government which has arrived at

558,000 as t h e n u m b e r o f v i l l a g e s i n India. They suggest

that every v i l l a g e have a panchayat. They t h e n l i s t the

number o f v i l l a g e s In Uttar Pradesh, f o r e x a m p l e , and say

that every v i l l a g e has a panchayat. There are 72,333 pan-


g
chayats i n Uttar Pradesh—there are 112,624 v i l l a g e s . It

follows that some o f t h e p a n c h a y a t s m u s t be c o m p o s e d o f mem-

bers f r o m m o r e t h a n one village. The village, thus, i s a

social unit one t i m e and an a d m i n i s t r a t i v e unit another.

Apparently the government uses whichever i s convenient.

I have i n c l u d e d the above p a r a g r a p h s t o show t h a t the

Indian government has an e s s e n t i a l l y different viewpoint

about the nature of l o c a l government than d i d the British

or, as we shall s e e , t h a n do the v i l l a g e r s themselves.


Ill

At the v i l l a g e level the t r a d i t i o n a l l y dominant caste

is still dominant--they are s t i l l able to control the affairs

of the v i l l a g e . As I pointed o u t i n t h e c h a p t e r on economic

allocation some o f t h e h o u s e h o l d s i n t h e v i l l a g e are no

l o n g e r dependent upon t h e v i l l a g e for their source of liveli-

hood. They a r e a b l e to find income outside the v i l l a g e . To

the extent that they are e c o n o m i c a l l y independent of the

dominant caste they are independent of the p o l i t i c a l control

of the dominant caste. The numbers o f h o u s e h o l d s a r e still

few, however, and the dominant caste merely i s o l a t e s or ignores

them. The bulk of the households are s t i l l dependent upon t h e

dominant caste for their livelihood. The panchayat still

operates to settle issues which a r i s e at the l o c a l level and

this is still s e e n as t h e p r i m a r y f u n c t i o n of the panchayat.

I would h y p o t h e s i z e t h a t t o the v i l l a g e r s the connection

between the panchayat and t h e Community D e v e l o p m e n t Plan i s

only a grafted on c o n c e p t b e c a u s e i t i s n o t an i n t e g r a l part

of the concept of the panchayat as a d e l i b e r a t i v e body. To

the villagers the panchayat i s a d e l i b e r a t i v e b o d y whose main

function i s not p o l i t i c a l but social. The officials at the

state and n a t i o n a l level saw the panchayat as p r i m a r i l y dealing

with political problems. They d i d t h i s because t h e y d i d and

do n o t u n d e r s t a n d t h e n a t u r e o f p o l i t i c a l activity at the vil-

lage level. At the s t a t e and n a t i o n a l level the p o l i t i c a l arena

is q u i t e wide and they have l o n g been accustomed to working


112

within i t . They a s s u r e d that the v i l l a g e r s w o u l d be a b l e t o

do so as w e l l . The a t t e m p t a t t h e s t a t e a n d n a t i o n a l level

to change t h e n a t u r e of the v i l l a g e p a n c h a y a t w o u l d be a

complete failure, j u s t a s was t h e B r i t i s h attempt, except

for one t h i n g - - T h e C o m m u n i t y D e v e l o p m e n t P l a n . The C o m m u n i t y

Development P l a n involves the expenditure of f a i r l y large sums

o f money (in village t e r m s ) on p r o j e c t s at the village level

and t h e P a n c h a y a t ! R a j and t h e Community Development P l a n will

share personnel.

The e f f e c t o f i n c l u d i n g t h e d i s p o s a l o f community develop-

ment f u n d s among t h e o t h e r functions of the v i l l a g e panchayat

has been t o Increase the l i k e l i h o o d of i n d i v i d u a l s other than

the traditionally powerful running f o r a p o s i t i o n on t h e o f f i -

cial panchayat. The s c o p e o f p o l i t i c a l activity has widened

in the v i l l a g e . In addition t o land ownership there i s now

competition f o r Community D e v e l o p m e n t funds.

I n many v i l l a g e s there a r e two p a n c h a y a t s operating.

The t r a d i t i o n a l panchayat still functions much as i t a l w a y s

has a n d t h e new o f f i c i a l panchayat functions mainly to dispose

of development funds, but i s g r a d u a l l y beginning t o take over

some o f t h e f u n c t i o n s of the t r a d i t i o n a l panchayat. The p r e s e n t

primary responsibilities of the o f f i c i a l panchayat include:

"Construction, r e p a i r maintenance, cleaning and l i g h t i n g o f

public s t r e e t s ; medical r e l i e f : s a n i t a t i o n ; r e g u l a t i n g the

construction o f a new b u i l d i n g ; a s s i s t i n g t h e d e v e l o p m e n t o f

agriculture, commerce a n d i n d u s t r y ; t h e a d m i n i s t r a t i o n o f
113

civil and c r i m i n a l j u s t i c e ; the construction and maintenance

of public wells, a n d t h e c a r e a n d management o f t h e common

grazing grounds. . . assisting and a d v i s i n g agriculturists

in the obtaining o f government l o a n s , development of co-

operation, and e s t a b l i s h m e n t o f i m p r o v e d seed and implement

stores." Most of these r e s p o n s i b i l i t i e s a r e new t o t h e

village. The a d m i n i s t r a t i o n of c i v i l and c r i m i n a l justice

and t h e c a r e and management o f w e l l s a r e about the only func-

t i o n s which might be i n c l u d e d w i t h i n the purview of the t r a d i -

tional panchayat.

The villages a r e n o t a b l e t o w i t h s t a n d t h e power o f t h e

state and so t h e y a r e f o r c e d to include t h e s e new functions

within their realm of p o l i t i c a l activity. Ralph Retzlaff

p r o v i d e s what i s p r o b a b l y t h e b e s t a n a l y s i s o f t h e way i n

which the o f f i c i a l panchayat operates i n the v i l l a g e . 1 0


He

studied the a c t i v i t i e s of the f i r s t two o f f i c i a l panchayats

In a village w h i c h he c a l l e d Khalapur. Three particular weak-

nesses prevented the f i r s t official panchayat from b e i n g very

effective; first, t h e weakness o f t h e e l e c t e d leader of the

panchayat; second, lack o f u n d e r s t a n d i n g by t h e members o f

the panchayat about t h e powers and d u t i e s of the panchayat;

and third, the Irregular pattern of p a r t i c i p a t i o n of the

e l e c t e d members. One o f t h e f i r s t items of business the o f f i -

cial panchayat c o n s i d e r e d was t h e t r o u b l e s o m e p r o b l e m o f

drunkenness i n the v i l l a g e . R e s o l u t i o n s were p a s s e d prohibit-

ing the manufacture, sale and c o n s u m p t i o n of alcoholic beverages

These r e s o l u t i o n s were s u p p o r t e d and passed by a m i n o r i t y of


114

the panchayat members—the others having stayed away. Among

those who stayed away w e r e some o f t h e more p o w e r f u l members

of the v i l l a g e . Khalapur i s a Rajput village. Several of

the Rajput factions w i t h i n the v i l l a g e supported the r e s o l u -

tion while several of the others refused t o . The R a j p u t s , who

would normally dominate the t r a d i t i o n a l panchayat, were unable

to dominate the o f f i c i a l panchayat because o f t h i s split.

Passage of other equally unenforceable r e s o l u t i o n s by t h e

official panchayat l e d t o almost complete inactivity by t h e

end o f t h e t e r m s o f t h e e l e c t e d members. Because o f this,

elections f o r membership i n the second official panchayat were

contested i n a different manner t h a n i n the f i r s t election.

The b a s i c d i f f e r e n c e was a concerted effort on t h e p a r t o f

the dominant Rajputs to control the e l e c t i o n . They d i d n o t

want t o g e t c a u g h t s h o r t as t h e y h a d i n t h e e a r l i e r election

by dividing their forces. As w e l l the other v i l l a g e r s had

had time t o s e e t h a t t h e new p a n c h a y a t was v e r y ineffective

b e c a u s e i t h a d no way of enforcing i t s decisions without the

consent of the Rajputs.

It i s interesting t o note that at the state l e v e l there i s

a realization that contested e l e c t i o n s might tend to Increase

conflict i n the v i l l a g e r a t h e r than decrease i t . 1 1


To avoid

this possibility a l l candidates who filed nomination papers

w e r e named i n a p o s t e d list for public scrutiny i n order that

other individuals m i g h t be a b l e t o q u e s t i o n t h e i r eligibility.

Each c a n d i d a t e had t e n days a f t e r filing f o r nomination during

w h i c h he c o u l d w i t h d r a w f r o m t h e c o n t e s t . The r e s u l t i s that
115

the real campaigning took p l a c e b e f o r e the o f f i c i a l election

in many c a s e s . The positions of the o f f i c i a l panchayat are

t h e n f i l l e d by a process which is traditional—each candidate

g a t h e r s h i s s u p p o r t f r o m among t h o s e who would have s u p p o r t e d

him i n the t r a d i t i o n a l panchayat.

I would hypothesize that the i n t r o d u c t i o n of official

panchayats into the v i l l a g e causes one of f i v e things to

happen; f i r s t , the o f f i c i a l panchayat i s t a k e n o v e r by the

already existent unofficial panchayat because only members

of the u n o f f i c i a l panchayat are a l l o w e d to campaign for

membership i n the o f f i c i a l panchayat; s e c o n d , t h e members

and attempted activities of the o f f i c i a l panchayat are

largely i g n o r e d by t h e r e s t of the v i l l a g e r s because they

lack any real power t o d i r e c t a c t i v i t i e s i n which event the

official panchayat becomes i n a c t i v e ; third, the o f f i c i a l and

the u n o f f i c i a l panchayats m a i n t a i n separate but a c t i v e exis-

tence clashing frequently over v i l l a g e centered issues; fourth,

the official panchayat b e c o m e s t h e mere l a c k of the already

established village leadership; and f i f t h , the o f f i c i a l pan-

c h a y a t becomes t h e s e a t o f r e a l power w i t h i n t h e village.

The outcome o f t h e c o n t e s t between t h e o f f i c i a l and unofficial

panchayats v a r i e s with the state of l o c a l l e a d e r s h i p , the kind

of organization ( t h o s e who are both f o r or against this new

way c a n m u s t e r ) , and finally t h e amount o f d e v e l o p m e n t funds

available f o r d i s p e r s i o n by t h e o f f i c i a l panchayat.
116

Earlier I defined p o l i t i c a l activity as t h a t activity

which centers around t h e c o n t r o l o f land as t h e s o u r c e of

wealth within the village. The e x i s t e n c e o f development

funds substantially enlarges t h e scope o f p o l i t i c a l activity.

Where b e f o r e political activity c o u l d be s a i d t o be confined

to t h e dominant caste i n the village i t i s no l o n g e r possible

to do s o . Some o f t h e s e a t s on t h e o f f i c i a l p a n c h a y a t were

reserved f o r untouchables a n d women n e i t h e r o f w h i c i were

granted an o f f i c i a l v o i c e i n the t r a d i t i o n a l panchayat. These

people a r e drawn i n t o the p o l i t i c a l arena t o d e a l w i t h only

certain types of p o l i t i c a l activity, but since a l l o f these

activities are connected they m u s t now b e c o n s i d e r e d as p a r t

of t h e p o l i t i c a l membership o f t h e v i l l a g e and as s u c h have

an effect on p o l i t i c a l activities which before were beyond

their purview.

So f a rI have d i s c u s s e d the effect of the coupling ofthe

Community Development P l a n w i t h the Panchayat! Raj w i t h i n a

single village. I would hypothesize that the effect i s even

greater on v i l l a g e s w h i c h must s h a r e membership i n t h e o f f i -

cial panchayat with an a d j a c e n t village. In addition tothe

effects on a s i n g l e v i l l a g e o u t l i n e d above t h e r e Is the effect

of b e i n g forced t o cooperate with the leadership of another

village. This forced cooperation could l e a d t o one o f t w o

courses of action. The f i r s t course o f a c t i o n m i g h t b e com-

plete i n a c t i o n because t h e two g r o u p s o f l e a d e r s stalemate

one another. V i l l a g e s have cooperated with one a n o t h e r i n t h e


117

p a s t b u t I t d i d not happen f r e q u e n t l y s i m p l y because there

was l i t t l e need or i n c l i n a t i o n t o do s o . I t was m o r e likely

that adjacent villages would quarrel—usually over boundaries.

The second course o f a c t i o n m i g h t be t h a t t h e o f f i c i a l pan-

chayat of t h e combined v i l l a g e s i s stronger than the t r a d i t i o n a l

panchayats o p e r a t i n g on t h e i r own i n e a c h o f t h e v i l l a g e s . I l -

ls not very likely that the o f f i c i a l panchayat c a n be captured

as i t i s when i n v o l v e d w i t h a s i n g l e village.

I am n o t s u r e w h a t c h a n g e s w i l l occur i n the economic

structure as t h e r e s u l t o f t h e changes I n t h e p o l i t i c a l struc-

ture, but I tend t o t h i n k that they will n o t be t o o f a r r e a c h -

ing i n the short r u n . The f u n d s channeled Into the v i l l a g e

through the o f f i c i a l panchayat are b e i n g used t o improve t h e

village i n terms o f s a n i t a t i o n and e d u c a t i o n , b u t t h e b u l k

of t h e funds are b e i n g used t o improve a g r i c u l t u r a l productivity

This can d i r e c t l y effect only those who own l a n d . The l a n d

owners w i l l find themselves w e a l t h i e r than ever relative to

those who own no l a n d . Since community development i s seen

as a self-liquidating program t h i s means t h a t o n l y i n t h e

short r u n can castes other than the dominant caste effect

village activities. The f u n d s c o n t r o l l e d by t h e o f f i c i a l

p a n c h a y a t m u s t be u s e d I n t h e m a i n t o i m p r o v e agricultural

output. T h i s i n t u r n means t h a t t h e d o m i n a n t c a s t e w i l l be

e v e n more w e a l t h y s o t h a t when t h e c o m m u n i t y d e v e l o p m e n t funds

cease to enter the v i l l a g e they w i l l have even f u l l e r control

over a l l others In the v i l l a g e who d e p e n d u p o n t h e m f o r

sustenance.
118

CONCLUSION

It i s my considered judgment t h a t the attempt to graft

a new way of o r g a n i z i n g p o l i t i c a l activity onto the tradi-

tional method w i l l fail—has failed in fact. In the short

run there i s probably more p a r t i c i p a t i o n by Individuals who

would not have p a r t i c i p a t e d w i t h i n the traditional panchayat

s y s t e m , but the participation is essentially meaningless

because i t comes f r o m a p o s i t i o n of powerlessness. Channel-

ing Community Development f u n d s t h r o u g h the formal panchayat

has appeared to give i t life and make i t a s u c c e s s , but there

Is an alternative way o f l o o k i n g a t what has happened. The

aim of the n a t i o n a l and s t a t e governments i s a r e o r g a n i z a t i o n

of p o l i t i c a l activity. The effect of t h e i r p r a c t i c e s has not

been r e o r g a n i z a t i o n , r a t h e r i t has been to I n c r e a s e the scope

of p o l i t i c a l activity at least temporarily. Political activity

is now centered around competition over c o n t r o l of land and

control of Community Development f u n d s . Since the state and

national governments have earmarked the major p o r t i o n of the

Community Development f u n d s f o r improvement of agricultural

production they have b u i l t failure into the attempted innova-

tion. No matter what k i n d o f r e o r g a n i z a t i o n t a k e s place the

fruits of the r e o r g a n i z a t i o n go t o the same p e o p l e . The caste

which i s already dominant has the power t o p r e v e n t the other

castes f r o m c o m p e t i n g and does so. The only r e a l effect i s to

provide the already dominant caste w i t h another source of power.

The traditional p a n c h a y a t has w e a k e n e d and i s becoming

weaker w i t h the passage of time. I t has weakened because i t


119

Is unable to solve t i e problems which are beginning to con-

front i t . These problems are brought a b o u t as the result of

increased contact and interaction with the world outside the

village. As the outside world impinges on the village i t can

less and l e s s be considered the relevant, local social unit.

So long as the other structures which I have discussed

in the earlier chapters continue to function, direct frontal

attacks by the n a t i o n a l and state governments, which the

Introduction of formal panchayats constitutes, w i l l not suc-

ceed. As long as roles are d i f f e r e n t i a t e d w i t h i n the village

in terms of p o s i t i o n w i t h i n the household and p o s i t i o n of one

household relative to others, employing the presently used

criteria, one cannot expect the i n t r o d u c t i o n o f new rules

governing p o l i t i c a l activity t o be effective--if they can

e v e n be understood.

Indian villagers are as fearful o f c h a n g e as anyone,

whether they are high caste or low caste, and they are well

aware t h a t the P a n c h a y a t i Raj i s an attempt from above to

force them t o change. T h e y may not know how o r why the force

Is being a p p l i e d , but they are aware t h a t i t exists, I am

sure .

The Indian n a t i o n a l and state governments a r e , I think,

correct In attempting to change the economic structure of

the village so that they can change the structures involved

in political activity. Their method of applying economic

force i s i l ladvised i n that i t supports the existing structure


120

rather t h a n c r e a t i n g new e c o n o m i c r o l e s . The e m p h a s i s on

improving a g r i c u l t u r a l production is a necessity in food

poor I n d i a , but it c a n n o t be e x p e c t e d t o change the nature

of p o l i t i c a l a c t i v i t y w i t h i n the village.

The t r a d i t i o n a l p a n c h a y a t is doomed—of t h i s there can

b e no d o u b t , b u t the o f f i c i a l panchayat has n o t h a d much of

a role In this change. In the l o n g run the Indian government

will be s u p p o r t e d b y d e m o c r a c y at the b o t t o m and t h e apparatus

for a c h i e v i n g t h i s may l o o k v e r y much l i k e the o f f i c i a l pan-

chayat of the present day, but the development o f a new type

of p o l i t i c a l o r g a n i z a t i o n w i l l evolve into existence not be

legislated Into existence. The r e o r g a n i z a t i o n w i l l come about

because the p o l i t i c a l arena Is larger (more b a s e s of power)

not because someone f r o m t h e top orders a revision of an

already adequate method.


121

FOOTNOTES

As n e a r l y a s I c a n d i s c e r n t h i s t e r m r e f e r s t o t h e
c o n c e p t h e l d by s t a t e a n d n a t i o n a l l e a d e r s t h a t government
i n I n d i a a t t h e l o c a l l e v e l w i l l be b y r o l e o f v i l l a g e p a n -
chayats--that p o l i t i c a l a c t i v i t y w i l l take place w i t h i n the
c o n f i n e s o f an o f f i c i a l l y e l e c t e d panchayat.

^Rad Nakumud M o o k e r j i , L o c a l Government i n A n c i e n t


India ( O x f o r d , 1920), p p . 36-52.
o
J
Hindustan Y e a r B o o k , p . 496•
4
R. D a y a l , C o m m u n i t y D e v e l o p m e n t , P a n c h a y a t ! Raj and
S a h a k a r i Sarnaj ( ( D e l h i , 1965), p . 7 1 .
5
I b i d . , p . 70.
^ T h i s c o n n e c t i o n between t h e p a n c h a y a t and t h e B l o c k i s
a c r i t i c a l f a c t o r i n the t h i n k i n g of the o f f i c i a l s at the
s t a t e and n a t i o n a l l e v e l . I t n e e d s some e x p l a n a t i o n . The
I n d i a n Community Development P l a n uses t h e c o n c e p t o f d e c e n -
tralization. T h e n a t i o n a l g o v e r n m e n t l a y s down t h e b r o a d
outlines of the plan. Since each s t a t e has d i f f e r e n t kinds
o f p r o b l e m s a n d p r i o r i t i e s i t i s l e f t up t o t h e s t a t e t o
f u r t h e r r e f i n e t h e program. The s t a t e g o v e r n m e n t t h e n p a s s e s
t h e p l a n o n t o t h e d i s t r i c t o f f i c i a l s who c o n t i n u e t o make
more e x p l i c i t t h e d i r e c t i v e s . B e l o w t h e d i s t r i c t l e v e l i s
the b l o c k l e v e l . E a c h b l o c k e n c o m p a s s e s somewhere b e t w e e n
50 a n d 100 v i l l a g e s — t h e r e a r e e x c e p t i o n s i n e i t h e r d i r e c t i o n .
The m a j o r i m p l i c a t i o n i s t h a t much o f t h e w o r k o f t h e p a n c h a y a t
w i l l be d e v o t e d t o community d e v e l o p m e n t . Theoretically
e x t e n s i v e communication s h o u l d pass back and f o r t h t h i s l i n e
o f a u t h o r i t y s o t h a t t h e l o w e r l e v e l s c a n h a v e some i n f l u e n c e
on t h e f o r m u l a t i o n o f p o l i c y . In practice there i s l i t t l e
c o m m u n i c a t i o n f r o m t h e b o t t o m upwards and t h i s has h u r t b o t h
the p a n c h a y a t and t h e development p l a n .

H i n d u s t a n Y e a r B o o k , p . 497.

Dayal, op_. c i t . , p . 77.

^M. P. S h a r m a , L o c a l Self-Government i n India (Bombay,


I960), pp. 57-8.
~^R. H. R e t z l a f f , V i l l a g e G o v e r n m e n t i n I n d i a (New Y o r k ,
1962) .

Ibid., p p . 90-91-
122

BIBLIOGRAPHY

B a d e n - P o w e l l , B. H. T h e L a n d S y s t e m s o f B r i t i s h India.
Oxford: C l a r e n d o n P r e s s , 1892.

B a i l e y , F. G. P o l i t i c s and S o c i a l Change: O r i s s a i n 1959 •


Berkeley: U n i v e r s i t y o f C a l i f o r n i a P r e s s , 1963-

. The J o i n t F a m i l y - I n d i a , "
;:
Economic Weekly.
Bombay, F e b r u a r y 2 0 , 1 9 6 0 .

. T r i b e , C a s t e , and N a t i o n . Manchester: Manchester


U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 196TT7

. C a s t e a n d t h e Ec o n o m i c F r o n t i e r . Manchester:
M a n c h e s t e r U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 1957-

. "Consensus as a p r o c e d u r e f o r making d e c i s i o n s i n
c o u n c i l s and committees," P o l i t i c a l Systems and t h e
D i s t r i b u t i o n o f Power. Association o f S o c i a l Anthro-
p o l o g i s t s M o n o g r a p h No. 2 . London: Tavistock Publica-
t i o n s , 1965.
Banton, Michael. P o l i t i c a l Systems and t h e D i s t r i b u t i o n o f
Power. Association of Social Anthropologists Monograph
No. 2 . London: T a v i s t o c k P u b l i c a t i o n s , 1965.

B a r n e s , J . A. P o l i t i c s i n a C h a n g i n g S o c i e t y . London:
Oxford U n i v e r s i t y Press 19L5^T.

B a r t h , F r e d r i k . P o l i t i c a l L e a d e r s h i p among Swat P a t h a n s .
L o n d o n S c h o o l o f E c o n o m i c s M o n o g r a p h s on S o c i a l
A n t h r o p o l o g y No . 19 , 1 9 5 9 a .

B e a l s , A l a n R. "Change I n t h e L e a d e r s h i p o f a M y s o r e V i l l a g e ,
India's V i l l a g e s . Calcutta: D e v e l o p m e n t D e p t . , West
B e n g a l , 1955a.
Gopalpur. New Y o r k : Holt, R i n e h a r t , a n d "Winston,
19T2 .
" I n t e r p l a y among f a c t o r s o f c h a n g e i n a M y s o r e
v i l l a g e , " V i l l a g e I n d i a , e d . McKIm M a r r i o t t . Chicago:
U n i v e r s i t y o f C h i c a g o P r e s s , 1955b.

B e l d e l m a n , Thomas 0. A C o m p a r a t i v e A n a l y s i s o f t h e J a j m a n i
System. Monographs o f t h e A s s o c i a t i o n f o r A s i a n S t u d i e s ,
WevTYork, 1959-
123

B e t e i l l e , Andre . C a s e , C l a s s and Power.


+
Manchester:
M a n c h e s t e r U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 1965.
. " P a t t e r n o f S t a t u s Groups," C a s t e and t h e Future,
S e m i n a r 70. New D e l h i (June 1965).
B l u n t , S i r Edward A r t h u r Henry. The C a s t e System o f N o r t h e r n
I n d i a w i t h S p e c i a l R e f e r e n c e t o the U n i t e d P r o v i n c e s o f
A g r a and Oudh. London: O x f o r d U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 1931.

Buck, P e a r l S. The Good E a r t h . New York: Reynal and H i t c h -


cock, 1936.
B u r g e s s , E. W., and H. J . L o c k e . The Family. New York:
A m e r i c a n Book, 1953.

C a r s t a i r s , G. M o r r i s . The Twice B o r n . London: Hogarth


Press, 1957-
C h a v a r r i a - A q u i l a r , 0. L. Traditional India. Englewood Cliffs,
N. J . : P r e n t i c e - H a l l I n c . , 1964.

C o l l v e r , Andrew. "The F a m i l y C y c l e - I n d i a and the United


S t a t e s , " ASR 28(1):86-96 ( F e b r u a r y 1 9 6 3 ) .

Cohn, B e r n a r d S. "Chamar F a m i l y i n a N o r t h Indian Village,"


Economic Weekly, 13:1051-1055, 1 9 6 l .
. "The c h a n g i n g s t a t u s o f a d e p r e s s e d c a s t e , " V i l l a g e
I n d i a , ed. McKIm M a r r i o t t . C h i c a g o : U n i v e r s i t y of
C h i c a g o P r e s s , 1955-
Cormack, M. L. She Who Rides a Peacock. New York: Praeger,
I n c . , 1961.
D a y a l , R. Community Development, P a n c h a y a t l Raj and S a h a k a r l
Samaj. D e l h i : M e t r o p o l i t a n Book Company, 1965.

D e r r e t t , J . D. M. "The H i s t o r y o f the J u r i d i c a l Framework


o f the H i n d u J o i n t F a m i l y , " C o n t r i b u t i o n s t o I n d i a n
S o c i o l o g y , V I (December 1962).
Demographic Yearbook: 1956 . S t a t i s t i c a l O f f i c e o f the United
N a t i o n s , Dept. o f Economic and S o c i a l A f f a i r s , New York.

D h i l l o n , B. L e a d e r s h i p and Groups - a South I n d i a V i l l a g e .


New D e l h i P l a n n i n g Commission, Program E v a l u a t i o n O r g a n i z a -
t i o n , Government o f I n d i a , 1955.
Dube, S. D. Indian V i l l a g e . Ithaca: Cornell University Press,
1955-
12 4

D u m o n t , L o u i s , a n d D. P o c o c k . "Village Studies," Contributions


t o I n d i a n S o c i o l o g y , No_. 1, 1957, p p . 23-42.

• "For a Sociology of I n d i a : a Pie j o i n d e r t o D r .


B a i l e y , " C o n t r i b u t i o n s t o I n d i a n S o c i o l o g y , No. 4, I 9 6 0 ,
p p . 82-89. ""
Dutt, N. K, O r i g i n a n d G r o w t h o f C a s t e In I n d i a . London:
K e g a n P a u l , T r e n c h , T r u b n e r a n d " C o m p a n y , L t d . , 1931.

E p s t e i n , T. S. E c o n o m i c D e v e l o p m e n t and S o c i a l Change i n
South I n d i a . Manchester: Manchester U n i v e r s i t y Press,

Fei, H s i a o Tung. Peasant L i f e i n China. London: 0. Routledge


a n d S o n s , 1939.

Forster, E. M. The Hill of Devi. London, 1953-

F u r n i v a l l , J . S. C o l o n i a l P o l i c y and P r a c t i c e . Cambridge:
C a m b r i d g e U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 19~4I3.

G o u g h , E. K a t h l e e n . "The S o c i a l S t r u c t u r e o f a T a n j o r e
V i l l a g e , " V i l l a g e I n d i a , ed. McKim M a r r i o t t . Chicago:
U n i v e r s i t y o f C h i c a g o P r e s s , 195 5.
H a r p e r , E d w a r d B., a n d L o u i s e G. H a r p e r . "Political Organiza-
t i o n I n a K a r n a t a k a V i l l a g e , ' L e a d e r s h i p and P o l i t i c a l
1

I n s t i t u t i o n s i r i I n d i a , e d s . R. L. P a r k a n d I . T i n k e r .
Princeton: P r i n c e t o n U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 1959-

H i t c h c o c k , J . T. "Leadership - a North Indian V i l l a g e : Two


Case S t u d i e s , " L e a d e r s h i p and P o l i t i c a l I n s t i t u t i o n s -
I n d i a , e d s . R. L . P a r k a n d I . T i n k e r , P r i n c e t o n : Princeton
University Press, 1959.

H u t t o n , J . H. Caste i n I n d i a : its_ Nature, Function and Origins


Cambridge: C a m b r i d g e U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 19 46 ~

Ibbetson, D. Punjab Castes. Lahore, 1916.

K a p a d i a , K. M. M a r r i a g e and F a m i l y i n I n d i a (2nd E d . ) . Bombay:


O x f o r d U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 1958 1

Karve, I r a w a t i . K i n s h i p Organis a t i o n i n I n d i a . Deccan C o l l e g e


Monograph S e r i e s No\"TT] Poona T Deccan C o l l e g e , 1953-

K o l e n d a , P a u l i n e M. " R e g i o n , C a s t e , and F a m i l y S t r u c t u r e : A
Comparative Study of the Indian ' J o i n t F a m i l y , " S t r u c t u r e
a n d C h a n g e i n I n d i a n S o c i e t y , e d s . M. S i n g e r a n d B. S.
Cohn". C h i c a g o : A l d i n e P u b l i s h i n g Company, 1968.
125

La P i e r r e , R i c h a r d T. S o c i a l C h a n g e . New Y o r k : McGraw-Hill
B o o k Company, 1 9 6 5 .

L e C l a i r , Edward E., J r . "The D y n a m i c s o f t h e P a n c h a y a t S y s t e m


o f M o d e r n I n d i a , " C o n t e m p o r a r y I n d i a , e d . B. N. V a r n a .
New Y o r k : A s i a P u b l i s h i n g H o u s e , 1964.

L e v y , M a r i o n J , J r . The S t r u c t u r e o f S o c i e t y . Princeton:
P r i n c e t o n U n i v e r s i t y Press, 1952.

. "Contrasting Factors - Modernization o f China and


Japan," unpublished manuscript.

. The F a m i l y R e v o l u t i o n i n M o d e r n C h i n a . Cambridge:
H a r v a r d U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 19^9-

Lewis, Oscar. "Group Dynamics i n a N o r t h I n d i a n V i l l a g e : A


Study I n F a c t i o n s , " Economic Weekly 6:423-25, 477-82,
501-6. Bombay, 1 9 5 4 .

. Village Life i nNorthern India. Urbana: University


of I l l i n o i s P r e s s , 195B.

M a j u m d a r , D. N. C a s t e a n d C o m m u n i c a t i o n i n a n I n d i a n Village.
New Y o r k : A s i a P u b l i s h i n g H o u s e , 195oT

M a n d e l b a u m , D. "The F a m i l y - I n d i a , " T h e F a m i l y : Its Function


a n d D e s t i n y , e d . R. N. A n s h e n . New Y o r k : Harper and
B r o t h e r s , 1949-
"The F a m i l y i n I n d i a , " I n t r o d u c t i o n t o C i v i l i z a t i o n
of~~India: Changing Dimensions o f Indian S o c i e t y and
Culture. Chicago: U n i v e r s i t y o f C h i c a g o P r e s s , 1957-

Mauss, M a r c e l . The G i f t : Forms a n d F u n c t i o n s o f Exchange i n


Archaic S o c i e t i e s , t r a n s l a t e d by I a nGunnison. Glencoe,
111.: F r e e P r e s s , 1954.

M a r r i o t t , McKim. " S o c i a l S t r u c t u r e a n d C h a n g e i n a, U. P.
V i l l a g e , " India's Villages. Calcutta: Development
D e p t . , West B e n g a l , 1955b.
, ed. " L i t t l e Communities i n an Indigenous C i v i l i z a t i o n , "
ViTlage I n d i a , Chicago: U n i v e r s i t y o f C h i c a g o P r e s s , 1955a.

ed. Village India. Chicago: U n i v e r s i t y o f Chicago


" P r e s s , 1955-
• S o c i a l S t r u c t u r e a n d C h a n g e - a U.P. V i l l a g e , "
~II37bnomIc W e e k l y , A u g u s t 2 3 , 1 9 5 2 .
126

M a y e r , A d r i a n C. C a s t e and K i n s h i p i n C e n t r a l I n d i a .
B e r k e l e y and L o s A n g e l e s : U n i v e r s i t y of C a l i f o r n i a
P r e s s , I960.

Pilot Project - India. U n i v e r s i t y of California


"Press, 1958.

Mencher, Joan. " C r o w i n g Up i n South Malabar," Human Organiza-


t i o j i ^ 22:54-65 , 1963.

Minturn, Leigh. " C h i l d T r a i n i n g , " S i x C u l t u r e s , Studies of


k i ' l i l i ? R e a r i n g , e d . B e a t r i c e B. W h i t i n g . New Y o r k and
London: J o h n W i l e y and S o n s , 1963.

, and J o h n T. H i t c h c o c k . "The R a j p u t s o f K h a l a p u r ,
I n d i a , " S i x C u l t u r e s , S t u d i e s of C h i l d R e a r i n g , ed.
B e a t r i c e B. W h i t i n g . New Y o r k and L o n d o n : John Wiley
and S o n s , 1963-

M o o t e r j i , Rad Nakumud. L o c a l Government i n A n c i e n t India.


Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1920.

M o o r e , W i l b e r t E. S o c i a l Change. Englewood C l i f f s , New Jersey:


P r e n t i c e - H a l l , I n c . , 1963•

M y r d a l , Gunnar. Rich L a n d s and Poor. New York: Harper and


Brothers, 1957-

Nair, Kusam. Blossoms i n the Dust. New York: Praeger, Inc.,


1962.

N a r a y a n , R. K. The B a c h e l o r of A r t s . East Lansing, Mich.:


Michigan State College Press, 1954.

N e a l e , W a l t e r C. India: The_ S e a r c h f o r U n i t y , Democracy,


and P r o g r e s s . Princeton: D. V a n N o s t r a n d Company, I n c . ,
196"5~
N i c h o l a s , R. W. "Pactions: A Comparative A n a l y s i s , " P o l i t i c a l
S y s t e m s and t h e D i s t r i b u t i o n o f Power. ASA M o n o g r a p h s No. 2.
New"York: Praeger, Inc., 1965-
, and T a r a s i s h M u k h o p a d h y a y . "Politics and Law i n
Two" West B e n g a l V i l l a g e s , " B u l l e t i n o f t h e Anthropological
S u r v e y o£ I n d i a 1 1 : 1 5 - 4 0 , 1962.

" S t r u c t u r e s of P o l i t i c s - the V i l l a g e s of S^utJaejrn


" A s i a , e ? t n ^ " i n g e r a n d B. S. C o h n . Chicago: Aldine
p L f T o l i s h i n g Company, 1968.

N i e h o f f , A r t h u r H. A Casebook of S o c i a l Change. Chicago:


A l d i n e P u b l i s h i n g Company, 19u"6\
127

O p l e r , M. E. " V i l l a g e L i f e - N o r t h I n d i a , " P a t t e r n s f o r
Modern L i v i n g . Chicago: Delphian Society, Division 3
C u l t u r a l P a t t e r n s , 1950.
, a n d R. S i n g h . "Two V i l l a g e s o f E a s t e r n U t t a r
Pradesh, India: An A n a l y s i s o f S i m i l a r i t i e s and D i f -
f e r e n c e s , " AA, V o l . 54, 1952.

O r e n s t e i n , Henry. "The R e c e n t H i s t o r y o f the Extended Family -


I n d i a , " S o c i a l Problems

Park, R . L., and I . T i n k e r . L e a d e r s h i p and P o l i t i c a l I n s t i -


tutions - India. Princeton: Princeton University Press,
1959.
P o c o c k , D. F . "The Movement o f C a s t e s , " M a n , (May 1955)>
pp. 71-72.
P o n s i o n e n , J . A. The A n a l y s i s o f S o c i a l C h a n g e R e c o n s i d e r e d -
A S o c i o l o g i c a l Study. S. G r a v e n h a g e : M o u t o n a n d Company,
19bT7_

R e t z l a f f , R a l p h H. V i l l a g e G o v e r n m e n t i n I n d i a : A Case Study.
Bombay: A s i a P u b l i s h i n g H o u s e , 19u~2.

R o s s , A i l e e n D. The H i n d u F a m i l y i n i t s U r b a n S e t t i n g .
Toronto: U n i v e r s i t y o f Toronto Press, 196l.

" C a s t e a n d The F u t u r e , " S e m i n a r 70, e d . Romesh T h a p a r .

S h a r m a , M. P. L o c a l S e l f - G o v e r n m e n t I n I n d i a . Bombay:
K i t a b M a h a l A l l a h a b a d , 1967J.

S r i n i v a s , M. N. C a s t e i n M o d e r n I n d i a a n d O t h e r Essays.
Bombay: A s i a P u b l i s h i n g H o u s e , 1962.

. R e l i g i o n a n d S o c i e t y Among t h e C o o r g s o f S o u t h
India. London: O x f o r d U n i v e r s i t y P r e s s , 1952.

"A N o t e o n S a n s k r i t i z a t i o n a n d W e s t e r n i z a t i o n , "
Far E a s t e r n Q u a r t e r l y , 1 5 ( 4 ) : 4 8 1 - 9 6 , 1955-

"The S o c i a l S y s t e m o f a M y s o r e V i l l a g e , " V i l l a g e
I_L1J.W.
n d iJ-CX
a ,y e^ d . M" "c^ K" i^ m M a r r i o t t .
^ *
Chicago: University of
Chicago Press, 1955-
Marriage and F a m i l y - Mysore. Bombay: New B o o k
Company, 1942.
S o c i a l Change i n Modern I n d i a . Berkeley: University
~~b~T~California P r e s s , 196TT
128

S t a t i s t i c a l A b s t r a c t of the Indian Union. Central S t a t i s t i c a l


O r g a n i z a t i o n , Dept. of S t a t i s t i c s , Govt, of I n d i a .
New D e l h i : G o v t , o f I n d i a P r e s s , New S e r i e s , #10.

T u r n e r , Roy, ed. India's Urban F u t u r e . U n i v e r s i t y of California


Press, 1962.

Weiner, Myron. Parties i n Indian Politics. Princeton:


Princeton University Press, 1957-

Wheeler, S i r Mortimer. C i v i l i z a t i o n s of the Indus V a l l e y and


Beyond. New Y o r k : M c G r a w - H i l l B o o k Company, 1966.

W i l s o n , H. C l y d e . J l c a r l l l a Apache P o l i t i c a l and E c o n o m i c
Structures. U n i v e r s i t y of C a l i f o r n i a P u b l i c a t i o n s i n
A m e r i c a n A r c h e o l o g y and E t h n o l o g y , 1964.

W i s e r , W. H. The H i n d u J a j m a n i System. Lucknow Publishing


H o u s e , 1936T

W i s e r , W. H. B e h i n d Mud Walls. New York: Agricultural


Missions, 1951-
APPENDIX

The concept of caste i s probably the most discussed

aspect of Indian life. I have b e f o r e me, in writing this

a p p e n d i x , n e a r l y a l l of the classic d i s c u s s i o n s of caste.

On some p o i n t s t h e r e Is complete a g r e e m e n t — and these I

shall merely l i s t — o n other points there is controversy.

A c a s t e I s an e n d o g a m o u s g r o u p , o r c o l l e c t i o n o f
e n d o g a m o u s g r o u p s , b e a r i n g a common name, membor-
Ghip of which i s h e r e d i t a r y , a r i s i n g from b i r t h
a l o n e ; i m p o s i n g on i t s members c e r t a i n r e s t r i c t i o n s
i n the matter of s o c i a l i n t e r c o u r s e ; e i t h e r

(i) f o l l o w i n g a common t r a d i t i o n a l o c c u p a t i o n , or
(11) c l a i m i n g a common o r i g i n , o r
(iii) both f o l l o w i n g such occupation and
c l a i m i n g s u c h o r i g i n ; and g e n e r a l l y
r e g a r d e d as f o r m i n g a s i n g l e homogene-
ous c o m m u n i t y . 1

The word c a s t e itself comes f r o m t h e L a t i n word CASTUS

meaning pure. The w o r d was originally u s e d by the Portuguese

to d e n o t e what t h e y t h o u g h t was the Indian system of social


2

classification to preserve the purity of blood. The system

which they though they were d e s c r i b i n g has a very long history

in India. There were four o r i g i n a l castes ( o r , as they are

sometimes called, varna—varna meaning c o l o u r ) . These four

castes (Brahmins, Kshatriyas, Vaishyas and Sudras) are said

to have been c r e a t e d s e p a r a t e l y from the mouth, the arms,

the thighs and the f e e t r e s p e c t i v e l y of the creator."^ These

four castes are seen i n the traditional literature of India

as a unified whole. Each p a r t i s related t o the other parts

129
130

and each Is necessary f o r the existence of the other. The

origin of other castes comes a b o u t i n one o f two ways accord-

ing to the traditional literature. The first way was by a

series of crosses b e t w e e n members o f t h e four o r i g i n a l varna.

Dutt provides a list of 29 ' c a s t e s which come i n t o existence

in this manner. The s e c o n d way t h a t new castes are formed i s

when t h e members o f t h e original varna failed to follow the

prescribed sacred rituals. The number o f c a s t e s gradually

increases through time and the number i s s t i l l increasing in

India today.

Whatever the way castes are formed, there are thousands

o f them o p e r a t i n g i n I n d i a t o d a y . W h i l e t h e r e may have been

little trouble identifying the number o f c a s t e s In the tradi-

tional literature, such i s not the c a s e i n modern I n d i a . The

greatest point of controversy i n present day discussions of

caste revolve around attempts to establish boundaries around

castes. The b a s i c problem i s t h a t subgroups w i t h i n a caste

may t h e m s e l v e s be endogamous. Since this I s one of the cri-

teria f o r d e f i n i n g a g r o u p as a c a s t e , the problem rises

Immediately: Is the group a c a s t e or a subcaste?

A d r i a n Mayer provides w h a t I t h i n k I s an excellent way

out of t h i s dilemma. He feels that there are effectively

three levels of membership i n a caste.

The l o w e s t i s t h a t o f an e f f e c t i v e l o c a l subcaste
p o p u l a t i o n which I c a l l the k i n d r e d of c o o p e r a t i o n .
T h i s v a r i e s f o r e a c h i n d i v i d u a l a t any t i m e , a n d
a r o u n d i t t h e r e I s a g r o u p w h i c h c a n be c a l l e d t h e
k i n d r e d of r e c o g n i t i o n . This i s the p o p u l a t i o n w i t h i n
131

w h i c h m a r r i a g e i L . a r e made a n d / o r k i n l i n k s c a n b e
t r a c e d t h r o u g h m u t u a l k i n . T h e s e two f e a t u r e s t e n d
t o go t o g e t h e r , f o r p e o p l e w i l l n o t make m a r r i a g e s
w i t h f a m i l i e s a b o u t w h i c h t h e y know n o t h i n g , a n d t h e
i n f o r m a t i o n runs along k i n s h i p channels. The k i n -
d r e d o f r e c o g n i t i o n forms a l a r g e and r a t h e r amor-
p h o u s b o d y , b e i n g much t h e same f o r members o f a
s i n g l e v i l l a g e ' s subcaste group . . . . Beyond
t h e s e t w o k i n d r e d s a r e p e o p l e who a r e r e c o g n i z e d
as members o f a s u b c a s t e w h i c h i s e n d o g a m o u s , named
and s e p a r a t e f r o m o t h e r c a s t e s . B u t i t u s u a l l y
s p r e a d s o v e r a w i d e a r e a and i s t h e r e f o r e n o t an
e f f e c t i v e group. S u b c a s t e s a r e m o s t l y b a s e d on
provincial distinction.

In r e a l i t y the question of subcastes seems c o b e impor-

tant o n l y t o t h o s e who a r e members o f t h e c a s t e . Those within

a caste d i f f e r e n t i a t e among t h e m s e l v e s and those who a r e o f

other c a s t e s s e e a l l members of that caste, regardless of

m e m b e r s h i p i n one s u b c a s t e or another, as t h e same. Caste

membership, i n o t h e r words, i s s i g n i f i c a n t for relations with

other c a s t e s and s u b c a s t e membership I s s i g n i f i c a n t f o r

activities within the caste.

Thus f o r t h i s study i t i s probably not Important t o worry

about t h e problem of subcastes simply because the caste group

at the l o c a l level i s t h e k i n d r e d o f c o o p e r a t i o n and most o f

its external relationships will be w i t h o t h e r c a s t e s a n d n o t

with other subcaste groups.

Castes are always ranked In the v i l l a g e . T h e r e seems t o

be no p r o b l e m s d e c i d i n g w h i c h c a s t e i s t h e h i g h e s t and which

is the lowest. I n the middle i t i s not quite so c l e a r - c u t .

As Ghurye r e m a r k s , " E x c e p t i n g t h e B r a h m i n a t one e n d a n d t h e

admittedly degraded castes l i k e the Holeyas at the other, the


132

members o f a l a r g e p r o p o r t i o n o f t h e Intermediate castes

thirji-: or p r o f e s s to think that t h e i r caste is better than

their neighbours.

There are s e v e r a l ways i n w h i c h r a n k i n g Is accomplished.

F1 t there are restrictions on who can e a t w i t h whom. There

a.rt.- two c a t e g o r i e s of food in village India—food cooked in

w a i / T and food c o o k e d I n ghee (clarified butter). Water-cooked

food will g e n e r a l l y be accepted only from caste mates. Ghee-

co'jked food w i l l be accepted from castes which are slightly

lower- than o n e ' s own. A high caste can accept water from a

low caste providing i t i s contained i n a particular kind of

c o n t a i n e r and not i f i t i s i n a different kind. A very low

caste individual can pollute a well f o r a l l others in the

village so t h a t t h e w a t e r i s u n d r i n k a b l e until appropriate

purification ceremonies are h e l d — u s u a l l y a bath o f some k i n d .

Cocial intercourse i s restricted. I n d i v i d u a l s of the

intermediate castes can mingle fairly f r e e l y but the high

castes and low c a s t e s have t o m a i n t a i n a careful distance

f r o m one another. To be t o u c h e d by a lowr c a s t e p e r s o n i s

polluting. In the south of I n d i a the shadow o f an untouchable

is as polluting as h i s t o u c h . I n some p l a c e s the untouchable

always keeps a s t a t e d d i s t a n c e from a h i g h caste individual.

A N a y a r may a p p r o a c h a M a n b u d i r i B r a h m i n b u t must
n o t t o u c h h i r n ; w h i l e a t i y a n must k e e p h i m s e l f a t
the d i s t a n c e of t h i r t y - s i x steps from the Brahmin,
and a P u l a y a n may n o t a p p r o a c h h i m w i t h i n n i n e t y -
s i x paces. A T i y a n m u s t k e e p away f r o m a N a y a r a t
133

t w e l v e p a c e s , w h i l e some c a s t e s may a p p r o a c h t h e
T i y a n , t h o u g h t h e y must n o t t o u c h h i m . '

It i s n o t q u i t e as r i g o r o u s a s e p a r a t i o n I n t h e n o r t h o f

India--one does n o t have t o m a i n t a i n a d i s t a n c e , but merely

not t o touch.

A third source of rank i n v o l v e s the kinds of activities

i n w h i c h t h e c a s t e s may i n d u l g e . High castes are freer t o

take up a n y o c c u p a t i o n t h a t they want. Low c a s t e individuals

are u s u a l l y t i e d to their occupations and any a t t e m p t s to

c h a n g e w o u l d b e met w i t h v i o l e n c e o n t h e p a r t of t h e upper

castes. High castes are able t o perform certain religious

rituals which the low caste individuals are not. T h e move-

ment of h i g h caste individuals through the village i s free.

Low c a s t e individuals are confined to certain parts of the

illage. To l e a v e t h e m a n d come t o t h e h i g h caste part of


v
the village i s to court violence. The c l o t h i n g w h i c h each

c a s t e wears i s p r e s c r i b e d . I understand from conversations

with a B e n g a l i language i n s t r u c t o r that i n present day I n d i a

even t h e k i n d o f u m b r e l l a one h a s i s d e t e r m i n e d b y c a s t e .
134

FOOTNOTES

1
E . A. H. B l u n t , The Caste System of Northern India
( L o n d o n , 1 9 3 1 ) , p . 5-

N. K. D u t t , O r i g i n a n d G r o w t h of Caste i n I n d i a
( L o n d o n , 1 9 3 1 ) , p . 1.
3
Ibld., p. 4.

^ I b i d . , pp. 7-8.

A. C. M a y e r , C a s t e a n d K i n s h i p i n Central India
(London, I 9 6 0 ) , pp. 4-7.

^G. S. Ghurye, C a s t e and Race i n I n d i a (London, 1932),


p. 6.
7
lbid., p. 9.

You might also like